blob: 3ec97dd9d11f362e07c0f79cf7fab3e5bf726ec4 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00003// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner4ee451d2007-12-29 20:36:04 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG. This pass is where
12// algebraic simplification happens.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000015// %Y = add i32 %X, 1
16// %Z = add i32 %Y, 1
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000017// into:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000018// %Z = add i32 %X, 2
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000019//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
Chris Lattner065a6162003-09-10 05:29:43 +000022// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000023// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +000025// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000027// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +000029// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000032// ... etc.
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000033//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000034//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000036#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
Chris Lattner022103b2002-05-07 20:03:00 +000037#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000038#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000039#include "llvm/Pass.h"
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000040#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000041#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
Chris Lattner79066fa2007-01-30 23:46:24 +000042#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +000043#include "llvm/Analysis/ValueTracking.h"
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000044#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
45#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
46#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000047#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +000048#include "llvm/Support/ConstantRange.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000049#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000050#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000051#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +000052#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000053#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
Chris Lattnera4f0b3a2006-08-27 12:54:02 +000054#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000055#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000056#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000057#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Reid Spencer551ccae2004-09-01 22:55:40 +000058#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000059#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000060#include <algorithm>
Torok Edwin3eaee312008-04-20 08:33:11 +000061#include <climits>
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000062#include <sstream>
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000063using namespace llvm;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000064using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000065
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000066STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
67STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
68STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
69STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
70STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
Chris Lattnera92f6962002-10-01 22:38:41 +000071
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000072namespace {
Chris Lattnerf4b54612006-06-28 22:08:15 +000073 class VISIBILITY_HIDDEN InstCombiner
74 : public FunctionPass,
75 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000076 // Worklist of all of the instructions that need to be simplified.
Chris Lattner2806dff2008-08-15 04:03:01 +000077 SmallVector<Instruction*, 256> Worklist;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000078 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned> WorklistMap;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000079 TargetData *TD;
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000080 bool MustPreserveLCSSA;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000081 public:
Nick Lewyckyecd94c82007-05-06 13:37:16 +000082 static char ID; // Pass identification, replacement for typeid
Dan Gohmanae73dc12008-09-04 17:05:41 +000083 InstCombiner() : FunctionPass(&ID) {}
Devang Patel794fd752007-05-01 21:15:47 +000084
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000085 /// AddToWorkList - Add the specified instruction to the worklist if it
86 /// isn't already in it.
87 void AddToWorkList(Instruction *I) {
Dan Gohman6b345ee2008-07-07 17:46:23 +000088 if (WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size())).second)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000089 Worklist.push_back(I);
90 }
91
92 // RemoveFromWorkList - remove I from the worklist if it exists.
93 void RemoveFromWorkList(Instruction *I) {
94 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned>::iterator It = WorklistMap.find(I);
95 if (It == WorklistMap.end()) return; // Not in worklist.
96
97 // Don't bother moving everything down, just null out the slot.
98 Worklist[It->second] = 0;
99
100 WorklistMap.erase(It);
101 }
102
103 Instruction *RemoveOneFromWorkList() {
104 Instruction *I = Worklist.back();
105 Worklist.pop_back();
106 WorklistMap.erase(I);
107 return I;
108 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000109
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000110
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000111 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
112 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
113 /// now.
114 ///
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000115 void AddUsersToWorkList(Value &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000116 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000117 UI != UE; ++UI)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000118 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000119 }
120
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000121 /// AddUsesToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add operands to
122 /// the work lists because they might get more simplified now.
123 ///
124 void AddUsesToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000125 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
126 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000127 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000128 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000129
130 /// AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist - The specified instruction is about to become
131 /// dead. Add all of its operands to the worklist, turning them into
132 /// undef's to reduce the number of uses of those instructions.
133 ///
134 /// Return the specified operand before it is turned into an undef.
135 ///
136 Value *AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(Instruction &I, unsigned op) {
137 Value *R = I.getOperand(op);
138
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000139 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
140 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i)) {
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000141 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000142 // Set the operand to undef to drop the use.
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000143 *i = UndefValue::get(Op->getType());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000144 }
145
146 return R;
147 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000148
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000149 public:
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000150 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +0000151
152 bool DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned ItNum);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000153
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000154 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +0000155 AU.addRequired<TargetData>();
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +0000156 AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
Chris Lattnercb2610e2002-10-21 20:00:28 +0000157 AU.setPreservesCFG();
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000158 }
159
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000160 TargetData &getTargetData() const { return *TD; }
161
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000162 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
163 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
164 // Return Value:
165 // null - No change was made
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000166 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000167 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000168 //
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000169 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
170 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
171 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000172 Instruction *visitURem(BinaryOperator &I);
173 Instruction *visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I);
174 Instruction *visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +0000175 bool SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000176 Instruction *commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
177 Instruction *commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +0000178 Instruction *commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
179 Instruction *commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
180 Instruction *visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
181 Instruction *visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
182 Instruction *visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000183 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
184 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
185 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000186 Instruction *visitShl(BinaryOperator &I);
187 Instruction *visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I);
188 Instruction *visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I);
189 Instruction *commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +0000190 Instruction *FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I, Instruction *LHSI,
191 Constant *RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000192 Instruction *visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I);
193 Instruction *visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I);
194 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +0000195 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
196 Instruction *LHS,
197 ConstantInt *RHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +0000198 Instruction *FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
199 ConstantInt *DivRHS);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000200
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000201 Instruction *FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
202 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond, Instruction &I);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000203 Instruction *FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000204 BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000205 Instruction *commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
206 Instruction *commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000207 Instruction *commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +0000208 Instruction *visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI);
209 Instruction *visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI);
210 Instruction *visitSExt(SExtInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +0000211 Instruction *visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000212 Instruction *visitFPExt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +0000213 Instruction *visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI);
214 Instruction *visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000215 Instruction *visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI);
216 Instruction *visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI);
217 Instruction *visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +0000218 Instruction *visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000219 Instruction *visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000220 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
221 Instruction *FI);
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +0000222 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &CI);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000223 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
224 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000225 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
226 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +0000227 Instruction *visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +0000228 Instruction *visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI);
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +0000229 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +0000230 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +0000231 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +0000232 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +0000233 Instruction *visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +0000234 Instruction *visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +0000235 Instruction *visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000236 Instruction *visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000237
238 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000239 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000240
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000241 private:
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +0000242 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000243 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +0000244 Instruction *transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +0000245 Instruction *transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
246 bool DoXform = true);
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +0000247 bool WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000248
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000249 public:
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000250 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
251 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
252 //
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000253 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
Chris Lattnere6f9a912002-08-23 18:32:43 +0000254 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
255 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000256 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
257 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000258 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000259 return New;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000260 }
261
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000262 /// InsertCastBefore - Insert a cast of V to TY before the instruction POS.
263 /// This also adds the cast to the worklist. Finally, this returns the
264 /// cast.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000265 Value *InsertCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opc, Value *V, const Type *Ty,
266 Instruction &Pos) {
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000267 if (V->getType() == Ty) return V;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000268
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000269 if (Constant *CV = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000270 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opc, CV, Ty);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000271
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000272 Instruction *C = CastInst::Create(opc, V, Ty, V->getName(), &Pos);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000273 AddToWorkList(C);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000274 return C;
275 }
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +0000276
277 Value *InsertBitCastBefore(Value *V, const Type *Ty, Instruction &Pos) {
278 return InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, V, Ty, Pos);
279 }
280
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000281
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000282 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
283 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
284 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
285 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
286 // modified.
287 //
288 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000289 AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000290 if (&I != V) {
291 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
292 return &I;
293 } else {
294 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
295 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +0000296 I.replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000297 return &I;
298 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000299 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000300
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000301 // UpdateValueUsesWith - This method is to be used when an value is
302 // found to be replacable with another preexisting expression or was
303 // updated. Here we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of
304 // I with the new value (unless the instruction was just updated), then
305 // return true, so that the inst combiner will know that I was modified.
306 //
307 bool UpdateValueUsesWith(Value *Old, Value *New) {
308 AddUsersToWorkList(*Old); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
309 if (Old != New)
310 Old->replaceAllUsesWith(New);
311 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Old))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000312 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +0000313 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(New))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000314 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000315 return true;
316 }
317
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000318 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
319 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
320 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
321 // this function.
322 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
323 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
324 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000325 RemoveFromWorkList(&I);
Chris Lattner954f66a2004-11-18 21:41:39 +0000326 I.eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000327 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
328 }
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +0000329
330 void ComputeMaskedBits(Value *V, const APInt &Mask, APInt &KnownZero,
331 APInt &KnownOne, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
332 return llvm::ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, TD, Depth);
333 }
334
335 bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, const APInt &Mask,
336 unsigned Depth = 0) const {
337 return llvm::MaskedValueIsZero(V, Mask, TD, Depth);
338 }
339 unsigned ComputeNumSignBits(Value *Op, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
340 return llvm::ComputeNumSignBits(Op, TD, Depth);
341 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000342
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +0000343 private:
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000344 /// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
345 /// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
346 /// casts that are known to not do anything...
347 ///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000348 Value *InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
349 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000350 Instruction *InsertBefore);
351
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000352 /// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for
353 /// commutative operators.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000354 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000355
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000356 /// SimplifyCompare - This reorders the operands of a CmpInst to get them in
357 /// most-complex to least-complex order.
358 bool SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I);
359
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +0000360 /// SimplifyDemandedBits - Attempts to replace V with a simpler value based
361 /// on the demanded bits.
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000362 bool SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
363 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
364 unsigned Depth = 0);
365
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000366 Value *SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
367 uint64_t &UndefElts, unsigned Depth = 0);
368
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000369 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a
370 // PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI
371 // (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
372 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I);
373
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000374 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
375 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
376 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
377 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000378 Instruction *FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
379
380
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000381 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantInt *OpRHS,
382 ConstantInt *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000383
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000384 Value *FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, ConstantInt *Mask,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000385 bool isSub, Instruction &I);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000386 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000387 bool isSigned, bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000388 Instruction *PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI, AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000389 Instruction *MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +0000390 bool SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000391 Instruction *SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI);
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +0000392 Instruction *SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000393
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000394
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +0000395 Value *EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty, bool isSigned);
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000396
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000397 bool CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
398 unsigned CastOpc,
399 int &NumCastsRemoved);
400 unsigned GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
401 unsigned PrefAlign = 0);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000402
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000403 };
404}
405
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +0000406char InstCombiner::ID = 0;
407static RegisterPass<InstCombiner>
408X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
409
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000410// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000411// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000412static unsigned getComplexity(Value *V) {
413 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
414 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) || BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000415 return 3;
416 return 4;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000417 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000418 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
419 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000420}
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000421
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000422// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
423// it.
424static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000425 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000426}
427
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000428// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
429// though a va_arg area...
430static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000431 if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
432 if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
433 return Type::Int32Ty;
Chris Lattner2b7e0ad2007-05-23 01:17:04 +0000434 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000435 return Ty;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000436}
437
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000438/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst or a constant
439/// expression bitcast, return the operand value, otherwise return null.
440static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
441 if (BitCastInst *I = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V))
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000442 return I->getOperand(0);
443 else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000444 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000445 return CE->getOperand(0);
446 return 0;
447}
448
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000449/// This function is a wrapper around CastInst::isEliminableCastPair. It
450/// simply extracts arguments and returns what that function returns.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000451static Instruction::CastOps
452isEliminableCastPair(
453 const CastInst *CI, ///< The first cast instruction
454 unsigned opcode, ///< The opcode of the second cast instruction
455 const Type *DstTy, ///< The target type for the second cast instruction
456 TargetData *TD ///< The target data for pointer size
457) {
458
459 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType(); // A from above
460 const Type *MidTy = CI->getType(); // B from above
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000461
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000462 // Get the opcodes of the two Cast instructions
463 Instruction::CastOps firstOp = Instruction::CastOps(CI->getOpcode());
464 Instruction::CastOps secondOp = Instruction::CastOps(opcode);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000465
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000466 return Instruction::CastOps(
467 CastInst::isEliminableCastPair(firstOp, secondOp, SrcTy, MidTy,
468 DstTy, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000469}
470
471/// ValueRequiresCast - Return true if the cast from "V to Ty" actually results
472/// in any code being generated. It does not require codegen if V is simple
473/// enough or if the cast can be folded into other casts.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000474static bool ValueRequiresCast(Instruction::CastOps opcode, const Value *V,
475 const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000476 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
477
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +0000478 // If this is another cast that can be eliminated, it isn't codegen either.
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000479 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000480 if (isEliminableCastPair(CI, opcode, Ty, TD))
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000481 return false;
482 return true;
483}
484
485/// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
486/// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
487/// casts that are known to not do anything...
488///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000489Value *InstCombiner::InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
490 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000491 Instruction *InsertBefore) {
492 if (V->getType() == DestTy) return V;
493 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000494 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, DestTy);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000495
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000496 return InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DestTy, *InsertBefore);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000497}
498
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000499// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
500// operators:
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000501//
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000502// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
503// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
504// binary operators.
505//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000506// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
507// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000508//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000509bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000510 bool Changed = false;
511 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
512 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000513
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000514 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
515 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000516 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
517 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
518 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000519 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(),
520 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
521 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000522 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
523 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
524 return true;
525 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
526 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
527 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
528 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
529 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
530
531 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000532 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000533 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::Create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000534 Op1->getOperand(0),
535 Op1->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000536 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000537 I.setOperand(0, New);
538 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
539 return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000540 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000541 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000542 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000543}
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +0000544
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000545/// SimplifyCompare - For a CmpInst this function just orders the operands
546/// so that theyare listed from right (least complex) to left (most complex).
547/// This puts constants before unary operators before binary operators.
548bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I) {
549 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) >= getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
550 return false;
551 I.swapOperands();
552 // Compare instructions are not associative so there's nothing else we can do.
553 return true;
554}
555
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000556// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
557// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000558//
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000559static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V) {
560 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000561 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000562
Chris Lattner0ce85802004-12-14 20:08:06 +0000563 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
564 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
565 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Nick Lewycky18b3da62008-05-23 04:54:45 +0000566
567 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
568 if (C->getType()->getElementType()->isInteger())
569 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
570
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000571 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000572}
573
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000574static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V) {
575 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000576 return BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000577
578 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000579 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000580 return ConstantInt::get(~C->getValue());
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000581 return 0;
582}
583
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000584// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
585// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000586// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
587// Otherwise, return null.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000588//
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000589static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST) {
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +0000590 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000591 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000592 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000593 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000594 return I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000595 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000596 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000597 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000598 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000599 uint32_t CSTVal = CST->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000600 CST = ConstantInt::get(APInt(BitWidth, 1).shl(CSTVal));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000601 return I->getOperand(0);
602 }
603 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000604 return 0;
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000605}
Chris Lattneraf2930e2002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000606
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +0000607/// dyn_castGetElementPtr - If this is a getelementptr instruction or constant
608/// expression, return it.
609static User *dyn_castGetElementPtr(Value *V) {
610 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) return cast<User>(V);
611 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
612 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
613 return cast<User>(V);
614 return false;
615}
616
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000617/// getOpcode - If this is an Instruction or a ConstantExpr, return the
618/// opcode value. Otherwise return UserOp1.
Dan Gohmanb99e2e22008-05-29 19:53:46 +0000619static unsigned getOpcode(const Value *V) {
620 if (const Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000621 return I->getOpcode();
Dan Gohmanb99e2e22008-05-29 19:53:46 +0000622 if (const ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000623 return CE->getOpcode();
624 // Use UserOp1 to mean there's no opcode.
625 return Instruction::UserOp1;
626}
627
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000628/// AddOne - Add one to a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000629static ConstantInt *AddOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000630 APInt Val(C->getValue());
631 return ConstantInt::get(++Val);
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000632}
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000633/// SubOne - Subtract one from a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000634static ConstantInt *SubOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000635 APInt Val(C->getValue());
636 return ConstantInt::get(--Val);
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000637}
638/// Add - Add two ConstantInts together
639static ConstantInt *Add(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
640 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() + C2->getValue());
641}
642/// And - Bitwise AND two ConstantInts together
643static ConstantInt *And(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
644 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & C2->getValue());
645}
646/// Subtract - Subtract one ConstantInt from another
647static ConstantInt *Subtract(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
648 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() - C2->getValue());
649}
650/// Multiply - Multiply two ConstantInts together
651static ConstantInt *Multiply(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
652 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() * C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000653}
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +0000654/// MultiplyOverflows - True if the multiply can not be expressed in an int
655/// this size.
656static bool MultiplyOverflows(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2, bool sign) {
657 uint32_t W = C1->getBitWidth();
658 APInt LHSExt = C1->getValue(), RHSExt = C2->getValue();
659 if (sign) {
660 LHSExt.sext(W * 2);
661 RHSExt.sext(W * 2);
662 } else {
663 LHSExt.zext(W * 2);
664 RHSExt.zext(W * 2);
665 }
666
667 APInt MulExt = LHSExt * RHSExt;
668
669 if (sign) {
670 APInt Min = APInt::getSignedMinValue(W).sext(W * 2);
671 APInt Max = APInt::getSignedMaxValue(W).sext(W * 2);
672 return MulExt.slt(Min) || MulExt.sgt(Max);
673 } else
674 return MulExt.ugt(APInt::getLowBitsSet(W * 2, W));
675}
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000676
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000677
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000678/// ShrinkDemandedConstant - Check to see if the specified operand of the
679/// specified instruction is a constant integer. If so, check to see if there
680/// are any bits set in the constant that are not demanded. If so, shrink the
681/// constant and return true.
682static bool ShrinkDemandedConstant(Instruction *I, unsigned OpNo,
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000683 APInt Demanded) {
684 assert(I && "No instruction?");
685 assert(OpNo < I->getNumOperands() && "Operand index too large");
686
687 // If the operand is not a constant integer, nothing to do.
688 ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(OpNo));
689 if (!OpC) return false;
690
691 // If there are no bits set that aren't demanded, nothing to do.
692 Demanded.zextOrTrunc(OpC->getValue().getBitWidth());
693 if ((~Demanded & OpC->getValue()) == 0)
694 return false;
695
696 // This instruction is producing bits that are not demanded. Shrink the RHS.
697 Demanded &= OpC->getValue();
698 I->setOperand(OpNo, ConstantInt::get(Demanded));
699 return true;
700}
701
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000702// ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given a signed integer type and a
703// set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
704// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
705// min/max.
706static void ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000707 const APInt& KnownZero,
708 const APInt& KnownOne,
709 APInt& Min, APInt& Max) {
710 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
711 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
712 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
713 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
714 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000715 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000716
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000717 // The minimum value is when all unknown bits are zeros, EXCEPT for the sign
718 // bit if it is unknown.
719 Min = KnownOne;
720 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
721
Zhou Sheng4acf1552007-03-28 05:15:57 +0000722 if (UnknownBits[BitWidth-1]) { // Sign bit is unknown
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000723 Min.set(BitWidth-1);
724 Max.clear(BitWidth-1);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000725 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000726}
727
728// ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given an unsigned integer type and
729// a set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
730// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
731// min/max.
732static void ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +0000733 const APInt &KnownZero,
734 const APInt &KnownOne,
735 APInt &Min, APInt &Max) {
736 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth(); BitWidth = BitWidth;
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000737 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
738 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
739 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() &&
740 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000741 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000742
743 // The minimum value is when the unknown bits are all zeros.
744 Min = KnownOne;
745 // The maximum value is when the unknown bits are all ones.
746 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
747}
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000748
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000749/// SimplifyDemandedBits - This function attempts to replace V with a simpler
750/// value based on the demanded bits. When this function is called, it is known
751/// that only the bits set in DemandedMask of the result of V are ever used
752/// downstream. Consequently, depending on the mask and V, it may be possible
753/// to replace V with a constant or one of its operands. In such cases, this
754/// function does the replacement and returns true. In all other cases, it
755/// returns false after analyzing the expression and setting KnownOne and known
756/// to be one in the expression. KnownZero contains all the bits that are known
757/// to be zero in the expression. These are provided to potentially allow the
758/// caller (which might recursively be SimplifyDemandedBits itself) to simplify
759/// the expression. KnownOne and KnownZero always follow the invariant that
760/// KnownOne & KnownZero == 0. That is, a bit can't be both 1 and 0. Note that
761/// the bits in KnownOne and KnownZero may only be accurate for those bits set
762/// in DemandedMask. Note also that the bitwidth of V, DemandedMask, KnownZero
763/// and KnownOne must all be the same.
764bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
765 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
766 unsigned Depth) {
767 assert(V != 0 && "Null pointer of Value???");
768 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
769 uint32_t BitWidth = DemandedMask.getBitWidth();
770 const IntegerType *VTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
771 assert(VTy->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
772 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
773 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
774 "Value *V, DemandedMask, KnownZero and KnownOne \
775 must have same BitWidth");
776 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
777 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
778 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & DemandedMask;
779 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & DemandedMask;
780 return false;
781 }
782
Zhou Sheng96704452007-03-14 03:21:24 +0000783 KnownZero.clear();
784 KnownOne.clear();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000785 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
786 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
787 // Just compute the KnownZero/KnownOne bits to simplify things downstream.
788 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
789 return false;
790 }
791 // If this is the root being simplified, allow it to have multiple uses,
792 // just set the DemandedMask to all bits.
793 DemandedMask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
794 } else if (DemandedMask == 0) { // Not demanding any bits from V.
795 if (V != UndefValue::get(VTy))
796 return UpdateValueUsesWith(V, UndefValue::get(VTy));
797 return false;
798 } else if (Depth == 6) { // Limit search depth.
799 return false;
800 }
801
802 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
803 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
804
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000805 APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0), LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
806 APInt &RHSKnownZero = KnownZero, &RHSKnownOne = KnownOne;
807 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +0000808 default:
809 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
810 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000811 case Instruction::And:
812 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
813 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
814 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
815 return true;
816 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
817 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
818
819 // If something is known zero on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
820 // LHS.
821 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
822 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
823 return true;
824 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
825 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
826
827 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
828 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and'.
829 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
830 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
831 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
832 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
833 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
834 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
835
836 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
837 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
838 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(VTy));
839
840 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
841 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
842 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
843
844 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
845 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
846 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
847 RHSKnownZero |= LHSKnownZero;
848 break;
849 case Instruction::Or:
850 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
851 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
852 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
853 return true;
854 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
855 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
856 // If something is known one on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
857 // LHS.
858 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
859 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
860 return true;
861 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
862 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
863
864 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
865 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or'.
866 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
867 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
868 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
869 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
870 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
871 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
872
873 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
874 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
875 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
876 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
877 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
878 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
879 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
880 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
881
882 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
883 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
884 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
885
886 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
887 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
888 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
889 RHSKnownOne |= LHSKnownOne;
890 break;
891 case Instruction::Xor: {
892 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
893 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
894 return true;
895 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
896 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
897 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
898 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
899 return true;
900 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
901 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
902
903 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
904 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'xor'.
905 if ((DemandedMask & RHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
906 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
907 if ((DemandedMask & LHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
908 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
909
910 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
911 APInt KnownZeroOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownZero) |
912 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne);
913 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
914 APInt KnownOneOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) |
915 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero);
916
917 // If all of the demanded bits are known to be zero on one side or the
918 // other, turn this into an *inclusive* or.
919 // e.g. (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
920 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & ~LHSKnownZero) == 0) {
921 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000922 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000923 I->getName());
924 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
925 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
926 }
927
928 // If all of the demanded bits on one side are known, and all of the set
929 // bits on that side are also known to be set on the other side, turn this
930 // into an AND, as we know the bits will be cleared.
931 // e.g. (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
932 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
933 // all known
934 if ((RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne) == RHSKnownOne) {
935 Constant *AndC = ConstantInt::get(~RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
936 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000937 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000938 InsertNewInstBefore(And, *I);
939 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, And);
940 }
941 }
942
943 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
944 // FIXME: for XOR, we prefer to force bits to 1 if they will make a -1.
945 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
946 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
947
948 RHSKnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
949 RHSKnownOne = KnownOneOut;
950 break;
951 }
952 case Instruction::Select:
953 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(2), DemandedMask,
954 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
955 return true;
956 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
957 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
958 return true;
959 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
960 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
961 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
962 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
963
964 // If the operands are constants, see if we can simplify them.
965 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
966 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
967 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 2, DemandedMask))
968 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
969
970 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
971 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
972 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
973 break;
974 case Instruction::Trunc: {
975 uint32_t truncBf =
976 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +0000977 DemandedMask.zext(truncBf);
978 RHSKnownZero.zext(truncBf);
979 RHSKnownOne.zext(truncBf);
980 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
981 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000982 return true;
983 DemandedMask.trunc(BitWidth);
984 RHSKnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
985 RHSKnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
986 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
987 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
988 break;
989 }
990 case Instruction::BitCast:
991 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->isInteger())
992 return false;
993
994 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
995 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
996 return true;
997 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
998 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
999 break;
1000 case Instruction::ZExt: {
1001 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1002 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001003 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001004
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001005 DemandedMask.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1006 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1007 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001008 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1009 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001010 return true;
1011 DemandedMask.zext(BitWidth);
1012 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1013 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1014 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1015 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1016 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001017 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001018 break;
1019 }
1020 case Instruction::SExt: {
1021 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1022 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001023 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001024
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001025 APInt InputDemandedBits = DemandedMask &
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001026 APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001027
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001028 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001029 // If any of the sign extended bits are demanded, we know that the sign
1030 // bit is demanded.
1031 if ((NewBits & DemandedMask) != 0)
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00001032 InputDemandedBits.set(SrcBitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001033
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001034 InputDemandedBits.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1035 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1036 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001037 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedBits,
1038 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001039 return true;
1040 InputDemandedBits.zext(BitWidth);
1041 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1042 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1043 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1044 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1045
1046 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1047 // top bits of the result.
1048
1049 // If the input sign bit is known zero, or if the NewBits are not demanded
1050 // convert this into a zero extension.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001051 if (RHSKnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1] || (NewBits & ~DemandedMask) == NewBits)
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001052 {
1053 // Convert to ZExt cast
1054 CastInst *NewCast = new ZExtInst(I->getOperand(0), VTy, I->getName(), I);
1055 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewCast);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001056 } else if (RHSKnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) { // Input sign bit known set
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001057 RHSKnownOne |= NewBits;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001058 }
1059 break;
1060 }
1061 case Instruction::Add: {
1062 // Figure out what the input bits are. If the top bits of the and result
1063 // are not demanded, then the add doesn't demand them from its input
1064 // either.
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00001065 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001066
1067 // If there is a constant on the RHS, there are a variety of xformations
1068 // we can do.
1069 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1070 // If null, this should be simplified elsewhere. Some of the xforms here
1071 // won't work if the RHS is zero.
1072 if (RHS->isZero())
1073 break;
1074
1075 // If the top bit of the output is demanded, demand everything from the
1076 // input. Otherwise, we demand all the input bits except NLZ top bits.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001077 APInt InDemandedBits(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001078
1079 // Find information about known zero/one bits in the input.
1080 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InDemandedBits,
1081 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1082 return true;
1083
1084 // If the RHS of the add has bits set that can't affect the input, reduce
1085 // the constant.
1086 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, InDemandedBits))
1087 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1088
1089 // Avoid excess work.
1090 if (LHSKnownZero == 0 && LHSKnownOne == 0)
1091 break;
1092
1093 // Turn it into OR if input bits are zero.
1094 if ((LHSKnownZero & RHS->getValue()) == RHS->getValue()) {
1095 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001096 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001097 I->getName());
1098 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1099 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1100 }
1101
1102 // We can say something about the output known-zero and known-one bits,
1103 // depending on potential carries from the input constant and the
1104 // unknowns. For example if the LHS is known to have at most the 0x0F0F0
1105 // bits set and the RHS constant is 0x01001, then we know we have a known
1106 // one mask of 0x00001 and a known zero mask of 0xE0F0E.
1107
1108 // To compute this, we first compute the potential carry bits. These are
1109 // the bits which may be modified. I'm not aware of a better way to do
1110 // this scan.
Zhou Shengb9cb95f2007-03-31 02:38:39 +00001111 const APInt& RHSVal = RHS->getValue();
1112 APInt CarryBits((~LHSKnownZero + RHSVal) ^ (~LHSKnownZero ^ RHSVal));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001113
1114 // Now that we know which bits have carries, compute the known-1/0 sets.
1115
1116 // Bits are known one if they are known zero in one operand and one in the
1117 // other, and there is no input carry.
1118 RHSKnownOne = ((LHSKnownZero & RHSVal) |
1119 (LHSKnownOne & ~RHSVal)) & ~CarryBits;
1120
1121 // Bits are known zero if they are known zero in both operands and there
1122 // is no input carry.
1123 RHSKnownZero = LHSKnownZero & ~RHSVal & ~CarryBits;
1124 } else {
1125 // If the high-bits of this ADD are not demanded, then it does not demand
1126 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001127 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001128 // Right fill the mask of bits for this ADD to demand the most
1129 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001130 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001131 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1132 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1133 return true;
1134 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1135 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1136 return true;
1137 }
1138 }
1139 break;
1140 }
1141 case Instruction::Sub:
1142 // If the high-bits of this SUB are not demanded, then it does not demand
1143 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001144 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001145 // Right fill the mask of bits for this SUB to demand the most
1146 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001147 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001148 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001149 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1150 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1151 return true;
1152 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1153 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1154 return true;
1155 }
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001156 // Otherwise just hand the sub off to ComputeMaskedBits to fill in
1157 // the known zeros and ones.
1158 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001159 break;
1160 case Instruction::Shl:
1161 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001162 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001163 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
1164 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001165 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1166 return true;
1167 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1168 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1169 RHSKnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
1170 RHSKnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
1171 // low bits known zero.
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001172 if (ShiftAmt)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00001173 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001174 }
1175 break;
1176 case Instruction::LShr:
1177 // For a logical shift right
1178 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001179 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001180
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001181 // Unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001182 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
1183 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001184 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1185 return true;
1186 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1187 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001188 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1189 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001190 if (ShiftAmt) {
1191 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001192 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001193 RHSKnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
1194 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001195 }
1196 break;
1197 case Instruction::AShr:
1198 // If this is an arithmetic shift right and only the low-bit is set, we can
1199 // always convert this into a logical shr, even if the shift amount is
1200 // variable. The low bit of the shift cannot be an input sign bit unless
1201 // the shift amount is >= the size of the datatype, which is undefined.
1202 if (DemandedMask == 1) {
1203 // Perform the logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001204 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001205 I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
1206 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1207 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1208 }
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00001209
1210 // If the sign bit is the only bit demanded by this ashr, then there is no
1211 // need to do it, the shift doesn't change the high bit.
1212 if (DemandedMask.isSignBit())
1213 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001214
1215 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00001216 uint32_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001217
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001218 // Signed shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001219 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Lauro Ramos Venanciod0499af2007-06-06 17:08:48 +00001220 // If any of the "high bits" are demanded, we should set the sign bit as
1221 // demanded.
1222 if (DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros() <= ShiftAmt)
1223 DemandedMaskIn.set(BitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001224 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001225 DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001226 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1227 return true;
1228 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1229 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1230 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001231 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001232 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1233 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
1234
1235 // Handle the sign bits.
1236 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
1237 // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
1238 SignBit = APIntOps::lshr(SignBit, ShiftAmt);
1239
1240 // If the input sign bit is known to be zero, or if none of the top bits
1241 // are demanded, turn this into an unsigned shift right.
Zhou Shengcc419402008-06-06 08:32:05 +00001242 if (BitWidth <= ShiftAmt || RHSKnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1] ||
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001243 (HighBits & ~DemandedMask) == HighBits) {
1244 // Perform the logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001245 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001246 I->getOperand(0), SA, I->getName());
1247 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1248 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1249 } else if ((RHSKnownOne & SignBit) != 0) { // New bits are known one.
1250 RHSKnownOne |= HighBits;
1251 }
1252 }
1253 break;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001254 case Instruction::SRem:
1255 if (ConstantInt *Rem = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1256 APInt RA = Rem->getValue();
1257 if (RA.isPowerOf2() || (-RA).isPowerOf2()) {
Nick Lewycky3ac9e102008-07-12 05:04:38 +00001258 if (DemandedMask.ule(RA)) // srem won't affect demanded bits
1259 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1260
Dan Gohman23e1df82008-05-06 00:51:48 +00001261 APInt LowBits = RA.isStrictlyPositive() ? (RA - 1) : ~RA;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001262 APInt Mask2 = LowBits | APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth);
1263 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2,
1264 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1265 return true;
1266
1267 if (LHSKnownZero[BitWidth-1] || ((LHSKnownZero & LowBits) == LowBits))
1268 LHSKnownZero |= ~LowBits;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001269
1270 KnownZero |= LHSKnownZero & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001271
1272 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1273 }
1274 }
1275 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001276 case Instruction::URem: {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001277 APInt KnownZero2(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne2(BitWidth, 0);
1278 APInt AllOnes = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001279 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), AllOnes,
1280 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
1281 return true;
1282
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001283 uint32_t Leaders = KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes();
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001284 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), AllOnes,
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001285 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
1286 return true;
1287
1288 Leaders = std::max(Leaders,
1289 KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes());
1290 KnownZero = APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, Leaders) & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001291 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001292 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001293 case Instruction::Call:
1294 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I)) {
1295 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1296 default: break;
1297 case Intrinsic::bswap: {
1298 // If the only bits demanded come from one byte of the bswap result,
1299 // just shift the input byte into position to eliminate the bswap.
1300 unsigned NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
1301 unsigned NTZ = DemandedMask.countTrailingZeros();
1302
1303 // Round NTZ down to the next byte. If we have 11 trailing zeros, then
1304 // we need all the bits down to bit 8. Likewise, round NLZ. If we
1305 // have 14 leading zeros, round to 8.
1306 NLZ &= ~7;
1307 NTZ &= ~7;
1308 // If we need exactly one byte, we can do this transformation.
1309 if (BitWidth-NLZ-NTZ == 8) {
1310 unsigned ResultBit = NTZ;
1311 unsigned InputBit = BitWidth-NTZ-8;
1312
1313 // Replace this with either a left or right shift to get the byte into
1314 // the right place.
1315 Instruction *NewVal;
1316 if (InputBit > ResultBit)
1317 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(I->getOperand(1),
1318 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), InputBit-ResultBit));
1319 else
1320 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I->getOperand(1),
1321 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), ResultBit-InputBit));
1322 NewVal->takeName(I);
1323 InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
1324 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1325 }
1326
1327 // TODO: Could compute known zero/one bits based on the input.
1328 break;
1329 }
1330 }
1331 }
Chris Lattner6c3bfba2008-06-18 18:11:55 +00001332 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001333 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001334 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001335
1336 // If the client is only demanding bits that we know, return the known
1337 // constant.
1338 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask)
1339 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(RHSKnownOne));
1340 return false;
1341}
1342
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001343
1344/// SimplifyDemandedVectorElts - The specified value producecs a vector with
1345/// 64 or fewer elements. DemandedElts contains the set of elements that are
1346/// actually used by the caller. This method analyzes which elements of the
1347/// operand are undef and returns that information in UndefElts.
1348///
1349/// If the information about demanded elements can be used to simplify the
1350/// operation, the operation is simplified, then the resultant value is
1351/// returned. This returns null if no change was made.
1352Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
1353 uint64_t &UndefElts,
1354 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001355 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001356 assert(VWidth <= 64 && "Vector too wide to analyze!");
1357 uint64_t EltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001358 assert((DemandedElts & ~EltMask) == 0 && "Invalid DemandedElts!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001359
1360 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
1361 // If the entire vector is undefined, just return this info.
1362 UndefElts = EltMask;
1363 return 0;
1364 } else if (DemandedElts == 0) { // If nothing is demanded, provide undef.
1365 UndefElts = EltMask;
1366 return UndefValue::get(V->getType());
1367 }
1368
1369 UndefElts = 0;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001370 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
1371 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001372 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1373
1374 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1375 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1376 if (!(DemandedElts & (1ULL << i))) { // If not demanded, set to undef.
1377 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1378 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1379 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i))) { // Already undef.
1380 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1381 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1382 } else { // Otherwise, defined.
1383 Elts.push_back(CP->getOperand(i));
1384 }
1385
1386 // If we changed the constant, return it.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001387 Constant *NewCP = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001388 return NewCP != CP ? NewCP : 0;
1389 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001390 // Simplify the CAZ to a ConstantVector where the non-demanded elements are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001391 // set to undef.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001392 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001393 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(EltTy);
1394 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1395 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1396 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1397 Elts.push_back((DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) ? Zero : Undef);
1398 UndefElts = DemandedElts ^ EltMask;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001399 return ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001400 }
1401
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001402 // Limit search depth.
1403 if (Depth == 10)
1404 return false;
1405
1406 // If multiple users are using the root value, procede with
1407 // simplification conservatively assuming that all elements
1408 // are needed.
1409 if (!V->hasOneUse()) {
1410 // Quit if we find multiple users of a non-root value though.
1411 // They'll be handled when it's their turn to be visited by
1412 // the main instcombine process.
1413 if (Depth != 0)
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001414 // TODO: Just compute the UndefElts information recursively.
1415 return false;
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001416
1417 // Conservatively assume that all elements are needed.
1418 DemandedElts = EltMask;
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001419 }
1420
1421 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
1422 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
1423
1424 bool MadeChange = false;
1425 uint64_t UndefElts2;
1426 Value *TmpV;
1427 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1428 default: break;
1429
1430 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
1431 // If this is a variable index, we don't know which element it overwrites.
1432 // demand exactly the same input as we produce.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001433 ConstantInt *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001434 if (Idx == 0) {
1435 // Note that we can't propagate undef elt info, because we don't know
1436 // which elt is getting updated.
1437 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1438 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1439 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1440 break;
1441 }
1442
1443 // If this is inserting an element that isn't demanded, remove this
1444 // insertelement.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001445 unsigned IdxNo = Idx->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001446 if (IdxNo >= VWidth || (DemandedElts & (1ULL << IdxNo)) == 0)
1447 return AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*I, 0);
1448
1449 // Otherwise, the element inserted overwrites whatever was there, so the
1450 // input demanded set is simpler than the output set.
1451 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0),
1452 DemandedElts & ~(1ULL << IdxNo),
1453 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1454 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1455
1456 // The inserted element is defined.
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001457 UndefElts &= ~(1ULL << IdxNo);
1458 break;
1459 }
1460 case Instruction::ShuffleVector: {
1461 ShuffleVectorInst *Shuffle = cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I);
1462 uint64_t LeftDemanded = 0, RightDemanded = 0;
1463 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
1464 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) {
1465 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
1466 if (MaskVal != -1u) {
1467 assert(MaskVal < VWidth * 2 &&
1468 "shufflevector mask index out of range!");
1469 if (MaskVal < VWidth)
1470 LeftDemanded |= 1ULL << MaskVal;
1471 else
1472 RightDemanded |= 1ULL << (MaskVal - VWidth);
1473 }
1474 }
1475 }
1476
1477 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), LeftDemanded,
1478 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1479 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1480
1481 uint64_t UndefElts3;
1482 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), RightDemanded,
1483 UndefElts3, Depth+1);
1484 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1485
1486 bool NewUndefElts = false;
1487 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
1488 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
1489 if (MaskVal == -1) {
1490 uint64_t NewBit = 1ULL << i;
1491 UndefElts |= NewBit;
1492 } else if (MaskVal < VWidth) {
1493 uint64_t NewBit = ((UndefElts2 >> MaskVal) & 1) << i;
1494 NewUndefElts |= NewBit;
1495 UndefElts |= NewBit;
1496 } else {
1497 uint64_t NewBit = ((UndefElts3 >> (MaskVal - VWidth)) & 1) << i;
1498 NewUndefElts |= NewBit;
1499 UndefElts |= NewBit;
1500 }
1501 }
1502
1503 if (NewUndefElts) {
1504 // Add additional discovered undefs.
1505 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1506 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; ++i) {
1507 if (UndefElts & (1ULL << i))
1508 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
1509 else
1510 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
1511 Shuffle->getMaskValue(i)));
1512 }
1513 I->setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
1514 MadeChange = true;
1515 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001516 break;
1517 }
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001518 case Instruction::BitCast: {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001519 // Vector->vector casts only.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001520 const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1521 if (!VTy) break;
1522 unsigned InVWidth = VTy->getNumElements();
1523 uint64_t InputDemandedElts = 0;
1524 unsigned Ratio;
1525
1526 if (VWidth == InVWidth) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001527 // If we are converting from <4 x i32> -> <4 x f32>, we demand the same
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001528 // elements as are demanded of us.
1529 Ratio = 1;
1530 InputDemandedElts = DemandedElts;
1531 } else if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1532 // Untested so far.
1533 break;
1534
1535 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1536 // then an input element is live if any of the corresponding output
1537 // elements are live.
1538 Ratio = VWidth/InVWidth;
1539 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx) {
1540 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << OutIdx))
1541 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio);
1542 }
1543 } else {
1544 // Untested so far.
1545 break;
1546
1547 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1548 // then an input element is live if the corresponding output element is
1549 // live.
1550 Ratio = InVWidth/VWidth;
1551 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1552 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << InIdx/Ratio))
1553 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << InIdx;
1554 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001555
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001556 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1557 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedElts,
1558 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1559 if (TmpV) {
1560 I->setOperand(0, TmpV);
1561 MadeChange = true;
1562 }
1563
1564 UndefElts = UndefElts2;
1565 if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1566 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1567 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1568 // then an output element is undef if the corresponding input element is
1569 // undef.
1570 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx)
1571 if (UndefElts2 & (1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio)))
1572 UndefElts |= 1ULL << OutIdx;
1573 } else if (VWidth < InVWidth) {
1574 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1575 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1576 // then a result element is undef if all of the corresponding input
1577 // elements are undef.
1578 UndefElts = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth); // Start out all undef.
1579 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1580 if ((UndefElts2 & (1ULL << InIdx)) == 0) // Not undef?
1581 UndefElts &= ~(1ULL << (InIdx/Ratio)); // Clear undef bit.
1582 }
1583 break;
1584 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001585 case Instruction::And:
1586 case Instruction::Or:
1587 case Instruction::Xor:
1588 case Instruction::Add:
1589 case Instruction::Sub:
1590 case Instruction::Mul:
1591 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1592 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1593 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1594 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1595 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1596 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1597 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1598
1599 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1600 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1601 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1602 break;
1603
1604 case Instruction::Call: {
1605 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I);
1606 if (!II) break;
1607 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1608 default: break;
1609
1610 // Binary vector operations that work column-wise. A dest element is a
1611 // function of the corresponding input elements from the two inputs.
1612 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1613 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1614 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_min_ss:
1615 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_max_ss:
1616 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1617 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1618 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_min_sd:
1619 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_max_sd:
1620 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1621 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1622 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1623 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(2), DemandedElts,
1624 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1625 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(2, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1626
1627 // If only the low elt is demanded and this is a scalarizable intrinsic,
1628 // scalarize it now.
1629 if (DemandedElts == 1) {
1630 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1631 default: break;
1632 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1633 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1634 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1635 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1636 // TODO: Lower MIN/MAX/ABS/etc
1637 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
1638 Value *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
1639 // Extract the element as scalars.
1640 LHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(LHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1641 RHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(RHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1642
1643 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1644 default: assert(0 && "Case stmts out of sync!");
1645 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1646 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001647 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001648 II->getName()), *II);
1649 break;
1650 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1651 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001652 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001653 II->getName()), *II);
1654 break;
1655 }
1656
1657 Instruction *New =
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001658 InsertElementInst::Create(UndefValue::get(II->getType()), TmpV, 0U,
1659 II->getName());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001660 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *II);
1661 AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*II, 0);
1662 return New;
1663 }
1664 }
1665
1666 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1667 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1668 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1669 break;
1670 }
1671 break;
1672 }
1673 }
1674 return MadeChange ? I : 0;
1675}
1676
Dan Gohman45b4e482008-05-19 22:14:15 +00001677
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001678/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
1679/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
1680/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
1681/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
1682/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
1683/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
1684/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
1685///
1686template<typename Functor>
Dan Gohman76d402b2008-05-20 01:14:05 +00001687static Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001688 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
1689 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
1690
1691 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
1692 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
1693 return F.apply(Root);
1694
1695 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
1696 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00001697 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001698 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
1699 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
1700
1701 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
1702 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
1703 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
1704 ShouldApply = true;
1705 }
1706
1707 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
1708 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
1709 if (ShouldApply) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001710 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
1711 // and perform the reassociation.
1712 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
1713
1714 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
1715 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
1716
1717 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
1718 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001719 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +00001720 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Constant::getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
1721 return 0;
1722 }
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001723 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001724 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001725 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001726 TmpLHSI->moveBefore(ARI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001727 ARI = Root;
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001728
1729 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
1730 // get to LHSI.
1731 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
1732 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001733 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
1734 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001735 NextLHSI->moveBefore(ARI);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001736 ARI = NextLHSI;
1737
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001738 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
1739 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
1740 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
1741 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
1742 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001743
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001744 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
1745 // the transformation...
1746 return F.apply(Root);
1747 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001748
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001749 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
1750 }
1751 return 0;
1752}
1753
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001754namespace {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001755
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001756// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001757struct AddRHS {
1758 Value *RHS;
1759 AddRHS(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
1760 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
1761 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001762 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Add.getOperand(0),
1763 ConstantInt::get(Add.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001764 }
1765};
1766
1767// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
1768// iff C1&C2 == 0
1769struct AddMaskingAnd {
1770 Constant *C2;
1771 AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c) : C2(c) {}
1772 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001773 ConstantInt *C1;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001774 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001775 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001776 }
1777 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001778 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001779 }
1780};
1781
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001782}
1783
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001784static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001785 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001786 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I)) {
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001787 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001788 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), SOC, I.getType());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001789
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001790 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(CastInst::Create(
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001791 CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType(), SO->getName() + ".cast"), I);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001792 }
1793
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001794 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001795 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
1796 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001797
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001798 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
1799 if (ConstIsRHS)
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001800 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
1801 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001802 }
1803
1804 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
1805 if (!ConstIsRHS)
1806 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
1807 Instruction *New;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001808 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001809 New = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,SO->getName()+".op");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001810 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001811 New = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001812 SO->getName()+".cmp");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001813 else {
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001814 assert(0 && "Unknown binary instruction type!");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001815 abort();
1816 }
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001817 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
1818}
1819
1820// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
1821// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
1822// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
1823// not have a second operand.
1824static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
1825 InstCombiner *IC) {
1826 // Don't modify shared select instructions
1827 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
1828 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
1829 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
1830
1831 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001832 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00001833 if (SI->getType() == Type::Int1Ty) return 0;
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001834
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001835 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
1836 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
1837
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001838 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
1839 SelectFalseVal);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001840 }
1841 return 0;
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001842}
1843
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001844
1845/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a PHI
1846/// node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI (which
1847/// is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
1848Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I) {
1849 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001850 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001851 if (!PN->hasOneUse() || NumPHIValues == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001852
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001853 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are constants. If there is
1854 // one non-constant value, remember the BB it is. If there is more than one
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001855 // or if *it* is a PHI, bail out.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001856 BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
1857 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
1858 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
1859 if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001860 if (isa<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) return 0; // Itself a phi.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001861 NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
1862
1863 // If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
1864 // loop.
1865 if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
1866 return 0;
1867 }
1868
1869 // If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
1870 // operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
1871 // inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
1872 // do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
1873 if (NonConstBB) {
1874 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1875 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
1876 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001877
1878 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001879 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(I.getType(), "");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00001880 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001881 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001882 NewPN->takeName(PN);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001883
1884 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
1885 if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
1886 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001887 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00001888 Value *InV = 0;
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001889 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001890 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1891 InV = ConstantExpr::getCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
1892 else
1893 InV = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001894 } else {
1895 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
1896 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001897 InV = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001898 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1899 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001900 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001901 InV = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001902 CI->getPredicate(),
1903 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1904 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001905 else
1906 assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
1907
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001908 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001909 }
1910 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001911 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001912 } else {
1913 CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
1914 const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001915 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001916 Value *InV;
1917 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001918 InV = ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001919 } else {
1920 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001921 InV = CastInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001922 I.getType(), "phitmp",
1923 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001924 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001925 }
1926 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001927 }
1928 }
1929 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
1930}
1931
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00001932
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00001933/// WillNotOverflowSignedAdd - Return true if we can prove that:
1934/// (sext (add LHS, RHS)) === (add (sext LHS), (sext RHS))
1935/// This basically requires proving that the add in the original type would not
1936/// overflow to change the sign bit or have a carry out.
1937bool InstCombiner::WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
1938 // There are different heuristics we can use for this. Here are some simple
1939 // ones.
1940
1941 // Add has the property that adding any two 2's complement numbers can only
1942 // have one carry bit which can change a sign. As such, if LHS and RHS each
1943 // have at least two sign bits, we know that the addition of the two values will
1944 // sign extend fine.
1945 if (ComputeNumSignBits(LHS) > 1 && ComputeNumSignBits(RHS) > 1)
1946 return true;
1947
1948
1949 // If one of the operands only has one non-zero bit, and if the other operand
1950 // has a known-zero bit in a more significant place than it (not including the
1951 // sign bit) the ripple may go up to and fill the zero, but won't change the
1952 // sign. For example, (X & ~4) + 1.
1953
1954 // TODO: Implement.
1955
1956 return false;
1957}
1958
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00001959
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001960Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00001961 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001962 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001963
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001964 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00001965 // X + undef -> undef
1966 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS))
1967 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
1968
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001969 // X + 0 --> X
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00001970 if (!I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) { // NOTE: -0 + +0 = +0.
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001971 if (RHSC->isNullValue())
1972 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001973 } else if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
Dale Johannesen9e3d3ab2007-09-14 22:26:36 +00001974 if (CFP->isExactlyValue(ConstantFP::getNegativeZero
1975 (I.getType())->getValueAPF()))
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001976 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001977 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001978
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001979 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001980 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00001981 const APInt& Val = CI->getValue();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001982 uint32_t BitWidth = Val.getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001983 if (Val == APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001984 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001985
1986 // See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
1987 // (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001988 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
1989 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
1990 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
1991 KnownZero, KnownOne))
1992 return &I;
1993 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001994 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001995
1996 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
1997 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
1998 return NV;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001999
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002000 ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
2001 Value *XorLHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +00002002 if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
2003 match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)))) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002004 uint32_t TySizeBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002005 const APInt& RHSVal = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getValue();
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002006
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002007 uint32_t Size = TySizeBits / 2;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002008 APInt C0080Val(APInt(TySizeBits, 1ULL).shl(Size - 1));
2009 APInt CFF80Val(-C0080Val);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002010 do {
2011 if (TySizeBits > Size) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002012 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
2013 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002014 if ((RHSVal == CFF80Val && XorRHS->getValue() == C0080Val) ||
2015 (RHSVal == C0080Val && XorRHS->getValue() == CFF80Val)) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002016 // This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00002017 if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS,
2018 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TySizeBits, TySizeBits - Size)))
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002019 Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002020 break;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002021 }
2022 }
2023 Size >>= 1;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002024 C0080Val = APIntOps::lshr(C0080Val, Size);
2025 CFF80Val = APIntOps::ashr(CFF80Val, Size);
2026 } while (Size >= 1);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002027
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002028 // FIXME: This shouldn't be necessary. When the backends can handle types
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00002029 // with funny bit widths then this switch statement should be removed. It
2030 // is just here to get the size of the "middle" type back up to something
2031 // that the back ends can handle.
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002032 const Type *MiddleType = 0;
2033 switch (Size) {
2034 default: break;
2035 case 32: MiddleType = Type::Int32Ty; break;
2036 case 16: MiddleType = Type::Int16Ty; break;
2037 case 8: MiddleType = Type::Int8Ty; break;
2038 }
2039 if (MiddleType) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00002040 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002041 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002042 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType(), I.getName());
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002043 }
2044 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002045 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002046
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002047 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2048 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
2049
Nick Lewycky7d26bd82008-05-23 04:39:38 +00002050 // X + X --> X << 1
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002051 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002052 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS))) return Result;
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002053
2054 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
2055 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2056 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
2057 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
2058 }
2059 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
2060 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2061 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
2062 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
2063 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002064 }
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002065
Chris Lattner5c4afb92002-05-08 22:46:53 +00002066 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002067 // -A + -B --> -(A + B)
2068 if (Value *LHSV = dyn_castNegVal(LHS)) {
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002069 if (LHS->getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
2070 if (Value *RHSV = dyn_castNegVal(RHS)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002071 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSV, RHSV, "sum");
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002072 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002073 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(NewAdd);
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002074 }
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002075 }
2076
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002077 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(RHS, LHSV);
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002078 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002079
2080 // A + -B --> A - B
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002081 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
2082 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002083 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, V);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002084
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002085
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002086 ConstantInt *C2;
2087 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2)) {
2088 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002089 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(RHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002090
2091 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
2092 ConstantInt *C1;
2093 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002094 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Add(C1, C2));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002095 }
2096
2097 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002098 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2) == LHS)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002099 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002100
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002101 // X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00002102 if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS) == RHS || dyn_castNotVal(RHS) == LHS)
2103 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002104
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002105
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002106 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002107 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002108 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2)))
2109 return R;
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002110
2111 // A+B --> A|B iff A and B have no bits set in common.
2112 if (const IntegerType *IT = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())) {
2113 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(IT->getBitWidth());
2114 APInt LHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2115 APInt LHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2116 ComputeMaskedBits(LHS, Mask, LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne);
2117 if (LHSKnownZero != 0) {
2118 APInt RHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2119 APInt RHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2120 ComputeMaskedBits(RHS, Mask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne);
2121
2122 // No bits in common -> bitwise or.
Chris Lattner9d60ba92008-05-19 20:03:53 +00002123 if ((LHSKnownZero|RHSKnownZero).isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002124 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002125 }
2126 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +00002127
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002128 // W*X + Y*Z --> W * (X+Z) iff W == Y
Nick Lewycky0c2c3f62008-02-03 08:19:11 +00002129 if (I.getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002130 Value *W, *X, *Y, *Z;
2131 if (match(LHS, m_Mul(m_Value(W), m_Value(X))) &&
2132 match(RHS, m_Mul(m_Value(Y), m_Value(Z)))) {
2133 if (W != Y) {
2134 if (W == Z) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002135 std::swap(Y, Z);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002136 } else if (Y == X) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002137 std::swap(W, X);
2138 } else if (X == Z) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002139 std::swap(Y, Z);
2140 std::swap(W, X);
2141 }
2142 }
2143
2144 if (W == Y) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002145 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, Z,
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002146 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002147 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(W, NewAdd);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002148 }
2149 }
2150 }
2151
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002152 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002153 Value *X = 0;
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002154 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002155 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(SubOne(CRHS), X);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002156
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002157 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
2158 if (LHS->hasOneUse() && match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002159 Constant *Anded = And(CRHS, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002160 if (Anded == CRHS) {
2161 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
2162 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002163 const APInt& AddRHSV = CRHS->getValue();
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002164
2165 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002166 APInt AddRHSHighBits(~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1));
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002167
2168 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002169 APInt AddRHSHighBitsAnd(AddRHSHighBits & C2->getValue());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002170
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002171 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
2172 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002173 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, CRHS,
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002174 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002175 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewAdd, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002176 }
2177 }
2178 }
2179
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002180 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
2181 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002182 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002183 return R;
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002184 }
2185
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002186 // add (cast *A to intptrtype) B ->
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002187 // cast (GEP (cast *A to sbyte*) B) --> intptrtype
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002188 {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002189 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHS);
2190 Value *Other = RHS;
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002191 if (!CI) {
2192 CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS);
2193 Other = LHS;
2194 }
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002195 if (CI && CI->getType()->isSized() &&
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00002196 (CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() ==
2197 TD->getIntPtrType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002198 && isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00002199 unsigned AS =
2200 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00002201 Value *I2 = InsertBitCastBefore(CI->getOperand(0),
2202 PointerType::get(Type::Int8Ty, AS), I);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002203 I2 = InsertNewInstBefore(GetElementPtrInst::Create(I2, Other, "ctg2"), I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002204 return new PtrToIntInst(I2, CI->getType());
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002205 }
2206 }
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002207
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002208 // add (select X 0 (sub n A)) A --> select X A n
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002209 {
2210 SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS);
2211 Value *Other = RHS;
2212 if (!SI) {
2213 SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(RHS);
2214 Other = LHS;
2215 }
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002216 if (SI && SI->hasOneUse()) {
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002217 Value *TV = SI->getTrueValue();
2218 Value *FV = SI->getFalseValue();
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002219 Value *A, *N;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002220
2221 // Can we fold the add into the argument of the select?
2222 // We check both true and false select arguments for a matching subtract.
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002223 if (match(FV, m_Zero()) && match(TV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Value(A))) &&
2224 A == Other) // Fold the add into the true select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002225 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), N, A);
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002226 if (match(TV, m_Zero()) && match(FV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Value(A))) &&
2227 A == Other) // Fold the add into the false select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002228 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), A, N);
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002229 }
2230 }
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00002231
2232 // Check for X+0.0. Simplify it to X if we know X is not -0.0.
2233 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS))
2234 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isPosZero() && CannotBeNegativeZero(LHS))
2235 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002236
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002237 // Check for (add (sext x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2238 // integer add followed by a sext.
2239 if (SExtInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(LHS)) {
2240 // (add (sext x), cst) --> (sext (add x, cst'))
2241 if (ConstantInt *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
2242 Constant *CI =
2243 ConstantExpr::getTrunc(RHSC, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
2244 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
2245 ConstantExpr::getSExt(CI, I.getType()) == RHSC &&
2246 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2247 // Insert the new, smaller add.
2248 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2249 CI, "addconv");
2250 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2251 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2252 }
2253 }
2254
2255 // (add (sext x), (sext y)) --> (sext (add int x, y))
2256 if (SExtInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(RHS)) {
2257 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2258 // single use (so we don't increase the number of sexts), and if the
2259 // integer add will not overflow.
2260 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2261 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2262 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2263 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2264 // Insert the new integer add.
2265 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2266 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2267 "addconv");
2268 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2269 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2270 }
2271 }
2272 }
2273
2274 // Check for (add double (sitofp x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2275 // integer add followed by a promotion.
2276 if (SIToFPInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(LHS)) {
2277 // (add double (sitofp x), fpcst) --> (sitofp (add int x, intcst))
2278 // ... if the constant fits in the integer value. This is useful for things
2279 // like (double)(x & 1234) + 4.0 -> (double)((X & 1234)+4) which no longer
2280 // requires a constant pool load, and generally allows the add to be better
2281 // instcombined.
2282 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS)) {
2283 Constant *CI =
2284 ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(CFP, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
2285 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
2286 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(CI, I.getType()) == CFP &&
2287 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2288 // Insert the new integer add.
2289 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2290 CI, "addconv");
2291 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2292 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2293 }
2294 }
2295
2296 // (add double (sitofp x), (sitofp y)) --> (sitofp (add int x, y))
2297 if (SIToFPInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(RHS)) {
2298 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2299 // single use (so we don't increase the number of int->fp conversions),
2300 // and if the integer add will not overflow.
2301 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2302 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2303 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2304 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2305 // Insert the new integer add.
2306 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2307 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2308 "addconv");
2309 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2310 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2311 }
2312 }
2313 }
2314
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002315 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002316}
2317
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002318Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002319 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002320
Chris Lattnerd137ab42008-07-17 06:07:20 +00002321 if (Op0 == Op1 && // sub X, X -> 0
2322 !I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002323 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002324
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002325 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002326 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002327 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, V);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002328
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002329 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
2330 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
2331 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2332 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
2333
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002334 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
2335 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A)...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002336 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002337 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1);
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002338
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002339 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002340 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002341 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002342 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, AddOne(C));
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002343
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00002344 // -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
2345 // -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002346 if (C->isZero()) {
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002347 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002348 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002349 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002350 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002351 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002352 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002353 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002354 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002355 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002356 }
2357 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002358 }
2359 else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
2360 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
2361 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002362 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002363 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002364 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002365 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002366 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002367 }
2368 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002369 }
2370 }
Chris Lattnerbfe492b2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00002371 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002372
2373 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
2374 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002375 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002376 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002377
2378 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2379 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2380 return NV;
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002381 }
2382
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002383 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2384 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
2385
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002386 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
2387 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002388 !Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002389 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002390 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002391 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002392 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002393 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
2394 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
2395 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002396 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(Subtract(CI1, CI2),
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002397 Op1I->getOperand(0));
2398 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002399 }
2400
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002401 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002402 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
2403 // is not used by anyone else...
2404 //
Chris Lattner0517e722004-02-02 20:09:56 +00002405 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002406 !Op1I->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002407 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
2408 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
2409 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
2410 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002411
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002412 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002413 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002414 }
2415
2416 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
2417 //
2418 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
2419 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
2420 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
2421
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +00002422 Value *NewNot =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002423 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(OtherOp, "B.not"), I);
2424 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002425 }
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002426
Reid Spencerac5209e2006-10-16 23:08:08 +00002427 // 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002428 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002429 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002430 if (CSI->isZero())
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002431 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002432 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002433 ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
2434
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002435 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002436 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002437 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2) == Op0) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002438 Constant *CP1 = Subtract(ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1), C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002439 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0, CP1);
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002440 }
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002441
2442 // X - ((X / Y) * Y) --> X % Y
2443 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
2444 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op1I->getOperand(0)))
2445 if (Op0 == I->getOperand(0) &&
2446 Op1I->getOperand(1) == I->getOperand(1)) {
2447 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002448 return BinaryOperator::CreateSRem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002449 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002450 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1I->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00002451 }
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002452 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002453 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002454
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002455 if (!Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002456 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002457 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002458 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
2459 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2460 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
2461 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002462 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
2463 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002464 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002465 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002466 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002467
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002468 ConstantInt *C1;
2469 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1)) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002470 if (X == Op1) // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002471 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op1, SubOne(C1));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002472
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002473 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
2474 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002475 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Subtract(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002476 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002477 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002478}
2479
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002480/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if the
2481/// comparison only checks the sign bit. If it only checks the sign bit, set
2482/// TrueIfSigned if the result of the comparison is true when the input value is
2483/// signed.
2484static bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate pred, ConstantInt *RHS,
2485 bool &TrueIfSigned) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002486 switch (pred) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002487 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // True if LHS s< 0
2488 TrueIfSigned = true;
2489 return RHS->isZero();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002490 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: // True if LHS s<= RHS and RHS == -1
2491 TrueIfSigned = true;
2492 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002493 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // True if LHS s> -1
2494 TrueIfSigned = false;
2495 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002496 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
2497 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask - 1
2498 TrueIfSigned = true;
2499 return RHS->getValue() ==
2500 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
2501 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
2502 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
2503 TrueIfSigned = true;
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00002504 return RHS->getValue().isSignBit();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002505 default:
2506 return false;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002507 }
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002508}
2509
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002510Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002511 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002512 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002513
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002514 if (isa<UndefValue>(I.getOperand(1))) // undef * X -> 0
2515 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2516
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002517 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002518 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2519 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002520
2521 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002522 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002523 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2524 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002525 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(SI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002526 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShOp));
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002527
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002528 if (CI->isZero())
Chris Lattner515c97c2003-09-11 22:24:54 +00002529 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X * 0 == 0
2530 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
2531 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2532 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002533 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002534
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +00002535 const APInt& Val = cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002536 if (Val.isPowerOf2()) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002537 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0,
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002538 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), Val.logBase2()));
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +00002539 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002540 } else if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002541 if (Op1F->isNullValue())
2542 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002543
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002544 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
2545 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
Chris Lattnerb8cd4d32008-08-11 22:06:05 +00002546 if (Op1F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2547 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
2548 } else if (isa<VectorType>(Op1->getType())) {
2549 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1))
2550 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
2551
2552 // As above, vector X*splat(1.0) -> X in all defined cases.
2553 if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1))
2554 if (ConstantFP *F = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantFP>(Op1V->getSplatValue()))
2555 if (F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2556 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002557 }
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002558
2559 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2560 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
Chris Lattner47c99092008-05-18 04:11:26 +00002561 isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002562 // Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002563 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002564 Op1, "tmp");
2565 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
2566 Value *C1C2 = ConstantExpr::getMul(Op1,
2567 cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(1)));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002568 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Add, C1C2);
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002569
2570 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002571
2572 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2573 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002574 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002575 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002576
2577 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2578 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2579 return NV;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002580 }
2581
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002582 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2583 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(I.getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002584 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002585
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002586 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2587 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
2588
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002589 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
2590 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
2591 // See if we can simplify things based on how the boolean was originally
2592 // formed.
2593 CastInst *BoolCast = 0;
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002594 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002595 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002596 BoolCast = CI;
2597 if (!BoolCast)
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002598 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002599 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002600 BoolCast = CI;
2601 if (BoolCast) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002602 if (ICmpInst *SCI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(BoolCast->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002603 Value *SCIOp0 = SCI->getOperand(0), *SCIOp1 = SCI->getOperand(1);
2604 const Type *SCOpTy = SCIOp0->getType();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002605 bool TIS = false;
2606
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002607 // If the icmp is true iff the sign bit of X is set, then convert this
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002608 // multiply into a shift/and combination.
2609 if (isa<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1) &&
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002610 isSignBitCheck(SCI->getPredicate(), cast<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1), TIS) &&
2611 TIS) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002612 // Shift the X value right to turn it into "all signbits".
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002613 Constant *Amt = ConstantInt::get(SCIOp0->getType(),
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002614 SCOpTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002615 Value *V =
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002616 InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002617 BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr, SCIOp0, Amt,
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002618 BoolCast->getOperand(0)->getName()+
2619 ".mask"), I);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002620
2621 // If the multiply type is not the same as the source type, sign extend
2622 // or truncate to the multiply type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002623 if (I.getType() != V->getType()) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002624 uint32_t SrcBits = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2625 uint32_t DstBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002626 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
2627 (SrcBits == DstBits ? Instruction::BitCast :
2628 (SrcBits < DstBits ? Instruction::SExt : Instruction::Trunc));
2629 V = InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, I.getType(), I);
2630 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002631
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002632 Value *OtherOp = Op0 == BoolCast ? I.getOperand(1) : Op0;
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002633 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, OtherOp);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002634 }
2635 }
2636 }
2637
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002638 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002639}
2640
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002641/// SimplifyDivRemOfSelect - Try to fold a divide or remainder of a select
2642/// instruction.
2643bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I) {
2644 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I.getOperand(1));
2645
2646 // div/rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div/rem X, Y
2647 int NonNullOperand = -1;
2648 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2649 if (ST->isNullValue())
2650 NonNullOperand = 2;
2651 // div/rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div/rem X, Y
2652 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2653 if (ST->isNullValue())
2654 NonNullOperand = 1;
2655
2656 if (NonNullOperand == -1)
2657 return false;
2658
2659 Value *SelectCond = SI->getOperand(0);
2660
2661 // Change the div/rem to use 'Y' instead of the select.
2662 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand));
2663
2664 // Okay, we know we replace the operand of the div/rem with 'Y' with no
2665 // problem. However, the select, or the condition of the select may have
2666 // multiple uses. Based on our knowledge that the operand must be non-zero,
2667 // propagate the known value for the select into other uses of it, and
2668 // propagate a known value of the condition into its other users.
2669
2670 // If the select and condition only have a single use, don't bother with this,
2671 // early exit.
2672 if (SI->use_empty() && SelectCond->hasOneUse())
2673 return true;
2674
2675 // Scan the current block backward, looking for other uses of SI.
2676 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &I, BBFront = I.getParent()->begin();
2677
2678 while (BBI != BBFront) {
2679 --BBI;
2680 // If we found a call to a function, we can't assume it will return, so
2681 // information from below it cannot be propagated above it.
2682 if (isa<CallInst>(BBI) && !isa<IntrinsicInst>(BBI))
2683 break;
2684
2685 // Replace uses of the select or its condition with the known values.
2686 for (Instruction::op_iterator I = BBI->op_begin(), E = BBI->op_end();
2687 I != E; ++I) {
2688 if (*I == SI) {
2689 *I = SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand);
2690 AddToWorkList(BBI);
2691 } else if (*I == SelectCond) {
2692 *I = NonNullOperand == 1 ? ConstantInt::getTrue() :
2693 ConstantInt::getFalse();
2694 AddToWorkList(BBI);
2695 }
2696 }
2697
2698 // If we past the instruction, quit looking for it.
2699 if (&*BBI == SI)
2700 SI = 0;
2701 if (&*BBI == SelectCond)
2702 SelectCond = 0;
2703
2704 // If we ran out of things to eliminate, break out of the loop.
2705 if (SelectCond == 0 && SI == 0)
2706 break;
2707
2708 }
2709 return true;
2710}
2711
2712
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002713/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
2714/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
2715/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
2716/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002717Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002718 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002719
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002720 // undef / X -> 0 for integer.
2721 // undef / X -> undef for FP (the undef could be a snan).
2722 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
2723 if (Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2724 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002725 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002726 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002727
2728 // X / undef -> undef
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002729 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002730 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002731
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002732 return 0;
2733}
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002734
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002735/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
2736/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2737/// division instructions.
2738/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002739Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002740 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2741
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002742 // (sdiv X, X) --> 1 (udiv X, X) --> 1
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002743 if (Op0 == Op1) {
2744 if (const VectorType *Ty = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
2745 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(Ty->getElementType(), 1);
2746 std::vector<Constant*> Elts(Ty->getNumElements(), CI);
2747 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
2748 }
2749
2750 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1);
2751 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CI);
2752 }
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002753
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002754 if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
2755 return Common;
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002756
2757 // Handle cases involving: [su]div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
2758 // This does not apply for fdiv.
2759 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
2760 return &I;
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002761
2762 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2763 // div X, 1 == X
2764 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
2765 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2766
2767 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
2768 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
2769 if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
2770 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002771 if (MultiplyOverflows(RHS, LHSRHS, I.getOpcode()==Instruction::SDiv))
2772 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2773 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002774 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002775 Multiply(RHS, LHSRHS));
Chris Lattnerbf70b832005-04-08 04:03:26 +00002776 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002777
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002778 if (!RHS->isZero()) { // avoid X udiv 0
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002779 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2780 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2781 return R;
2782 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2783 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2784 return NV;
2785 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002786 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002787
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002788 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002789 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002790 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
2791 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2792
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002793 // It can't be division by zero, hence it must be division by one.
2794 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2795 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2796
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002797 return 0;
2798}
2799
2800Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2801 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2802
2803 // Handle the integer div common cases
2804 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2805 return Common;
2806
2807 // X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
2808 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
2809 // if so, convert to a right shift.
2810 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00002811 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2()) // 0 not included in isPowerOf2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002812 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0,
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002813 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), C->getValue().logBase2()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002814 }
2815
2816 // X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002817 if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002818 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2819 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002820 const APInt& C1 = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002821 if (C1.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002822 Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002823 const Type *NTy = N->getType();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002824 if (uint32_t C2 = C1.logBase2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002825 Constant *C2V = ConstantInt::get(NTy, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002826 N = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(N, C2V, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002827 }
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002828 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, N);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002829 }
2830 }
Chris Lattnerc812e5d2005-11-05 07:40:31 +00002831 }
2832
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002833 // udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
2834 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002835 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002836 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002837 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002838 const APInt &TVA = STO->getValue(), &FVA = SFO->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002839 if (TVA.isPowerOf2() && FVA.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002840 // Compute the shift amounts
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002841 uint32_t TSA = TVA.logBase2(), FSA = FVA.logBase2();
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002842 // Construct the "on true" case of the select
2843 Constant *TC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), TSA);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002844 Instruction *TSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002845 Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
2846 TSI = InsertNewInstBefore(TSI, I);
2847
2848 // Construct the "on false" case of the select
2849 Constant *FC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), FSA);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002850 Instruction *FSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002851 Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
2852 FSI = InsertNewInstBefore(FSI, I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002853
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002854 // construct the select instruction and return it.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002855 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002856 }
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002857 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002858 return 0;
2859}
2860
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002861Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2862 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2863
2864 // Handle the integer div common cases
2865 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2866 return Common;
2867
2868 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2869 // sdiv X, -1 == -X
2870 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002871 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002872
2873 // -X/C -> X/-C
2874 if (Value *LHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op0))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002875 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(LHSNeg, ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002876 }
2877
2878 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2879 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00002880 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002881 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002882 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002883 // X sdiv Y -> X udiv Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002884 return BinaryOperator::CreateUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002885 }
2886 }
2887
2888 return 0;
2889}
2890
2891Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2892 return commonDivTransforms(I);
2893}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002894
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002895/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
2896/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
2897/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
2898/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
2899Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002900 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002901
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002902 // 0 % X == 0 for integer, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002903 if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
2904 if (LHS->isNullValue())
2905 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2906
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002907 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) { // undef % X -> 0
2908 if (I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2909 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X % undef -> undef (could be SNaN)
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002910 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002911 }
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002912 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2913 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002914
2915 // Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002916 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
2917 return &I;
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002918
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002919 return 0;
2920}
2921
2922/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
2923/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2924/// remainder instructions.
2925/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
2926Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
2927 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2928
2929 if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
2930 return common;
2931
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002932 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002933 // X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
2934 if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
2935 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
2936
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002937 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
2938 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2939
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002940 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
2941 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
2942 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2943 return R;
2944 } else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
2945 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2946 return NV;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002947 }
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00002948
2949 // See if we can fold away this rem instruction.
2950 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
2951 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
2952 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
2953 KnownZero, KnownOne))
2954 return &I;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002955 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002956 }
2957
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002958 return 0;
2959}
2960
2961Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2962 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2963
2964 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2965 return common;
2966
2967 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2968 // X urem C^2 -> X and C
2969 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
2970 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
2971 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002972 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002973 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(C));
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002974 }
2975
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002976 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002977 // Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
2978 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2979 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002980 if (cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002981 Constant *N1 = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002982 Value *Add = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(RHSI, N1,
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002983 "tmp"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002984 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, Add);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002985 }
2986 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002987 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002988
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002989 // urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
2990 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
2991 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2992 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2993 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
2994 // STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002995 if ((STO->getValue().isPowerOf2()) &&
2996 (SFO->getValue().isPowerOf2())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002997 Value *TrueAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002998 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO), SI->getName()+".t"), I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002999 Value *FalseAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003000 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO), SI->getName()+".f"), I);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00003001 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003002 }
3003 }
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003004 }
3005
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003006 return 0;
3007}
3008
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003009Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
3010 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3011
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003012 // Handle the integer rem common cases
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003013 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
3014 return common;
3015
3016 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00003017 if (!isa<Constant>(RHSNeg) ||
3018 (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) &&
3019 cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue().isStrictlyPositive())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003020 // X % -Y -> X % Y
3021 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
3022 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
3023 return &I;
3024 }
3025
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003026 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003027 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003028 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
3029 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
3030 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
3031 // X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003032 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003033 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003034 }
3035
3036 return 0;
3037}
3038
3039Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003040 return commonRemTransforms(I);
3041}
3042
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003043// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
3044// constant.
3045static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencer5f6a8952007-03-20 00:16:52 +00003046 return CI->getValue().isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003047}
3048
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00003049// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
3050// This is the same as lowones(~X).
3051static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng2cde46c2007-03-20 12:49:06 +00003052 return (~CI->getValue() + 1).isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00003053}
3054
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003055/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003056/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
3057///
3058/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
3059///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003060/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
3061/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003062///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003063/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
3064/// 0 A > B
3065/// 1 A == B
3066/// 2 A < B
3067///
3068/// <=> Value Definition
3069/// 000 0 Always false
3070/// 001 1 A > B
3071/// 010 2 A == B
3072/// 011 3 A >= B
3073/// 100 4 A < B
3074/// 101 5 A != B
3075/// 110 6 A <= B
3076/// 111 7 Always true
3077///
3078static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
3079 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003080 // False -> 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003081 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3082 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
3083 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
3084 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3085 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
3086 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
3087 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
3088 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
3089 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
3090 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003091 // True -> 7
3092 default:
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003093 assert(0 && "Invalid ICmp predicate!");
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003094 return 0;
3095 }
3096}
3097
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003098/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
3099/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00003100/// new ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003101/// of predicate to use in new icmp instructions.
3102static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
3103 switch (code) {
3104 default: assert(0 && "Illegal ICmp code!");
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003105 case 0: return ConstantInt::getFalse();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003106 case 1:
3107 if (sign)
3108 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
3109 else
3110 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
3111 case 2: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
3112 case 3:
3113 if (sign)
3114 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
3115 else
3116 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
3117 case 4:
3118 if (sign)
3119 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
3120 else
3121 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
3122 case 5: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
3123 case 6:
3124 if (sign)
3125 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
3126 else
3127 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003128 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003129 }
3130}
3131
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003132static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
3133 return (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) == ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2)) ||
3134 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) &&
3135 (p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)) ||
3136 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2) &&
3137 (p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE));
3138}
3139
3140namespace {
3141// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3142struct FoldICmpLogical {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003143 InstCombiner &IC;
3144 Value *LHS, *RHS;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003145 ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
3146 FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
3147 : IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
3148 pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003149 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003150 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
3151 if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003152 return ((ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS) ||
3153 (ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS));
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003154 return false;
3155 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003156 Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
3157 ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
3158 if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
3159 assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
3160 ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003161 }
3162
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003163 ICmpInst *RHSICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003164 unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003165 unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(RHSICI);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003166 unsigned Code;
3167 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
3168 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
3169 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
3170 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
Chris Lattner021c1902003-09-22 20:33:34 +00003171 default: assert(0 && "Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003172 }
3173
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003174 bool isSigned = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSICI->getPredicate()) ||
3175 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
3176
3177 Value *RV = getICmpValue(isSigned, Code, LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003178 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
3179 return I;
3180 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
3181 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
3182 }
3183};
Chris Lattnerd23b5ba2006-11-15 04:53:24 +00003184} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003185
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003186// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
3187// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003188// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003189Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003190 ConstantInt *OpRHS,
3191 ConstantInt *AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003192 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
3193 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner76f7fe22004-01-12 19:47:05 +00003194 Constant *Together = 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003195 if (!Op->isShift())
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003196 Together = And(AndRHS, OpRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00003197
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003198 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
3199 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003200 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003201 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003202 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003203 InsertNewInstBefore(And, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003204 And->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003205 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(And, Together);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003206 }
3207 break;
3208 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003209 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
3210 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003211
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003212 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
3213 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003214 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, Together);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003215 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003216 Or->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003217 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003218 }
3219 break;
3220 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00003221 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003222 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
3223 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
3224 // single bit constant.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003225 const APInt& AndRHSV = cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getValue();
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003226
3227 // If there is only one bit set...
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003228 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003229 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
3230 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
3231 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003232 const APInt& AddRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getValue();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003233
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003234 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
3235 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
3236 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
3237 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
3238 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
3239 // no effect.
3240 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
3241 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
3242 return &TheAnd;
3243 } else {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003244 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003245 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003246 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003247 NewAnd->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003248 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003249 }
3250 }
3251 }
3252 }
3253 break;
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003254
3255 case Instruction::Shl: {
3256 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3257 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
3258 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003259 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003260 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003261 APInt ShlMask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-OpRHSVal));
3262 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShlMask);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003263
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003264 if (CI->getValue() == ShlMask) {
3265 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003266 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
3267 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003268 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
3269 return &TheAnd;
3270 }
3271 break;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003272 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003273 case Instruction::LShr:
3274 {
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003275 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3276 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
3277 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
3278 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003279 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003280 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003281 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3282 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003283
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003284 if (CI->getValue() == ShrMask) {
3285 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003286 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
3287 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
3288 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
3289 return &TheAnd;
3290 }
3291 break;
3292 }
3293 case Instruction::AShr:
3294 // Signed shr.
3295 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
3296 // with an and.
3297 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003298 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003299 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003300 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3301 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003302 if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00003303 // (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003304 // Make the argument unsigned.
3305 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003306 ShVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003307 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(ShVal, OpRHS,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003308 Op->getName()), TheAnd);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003309 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003310 }
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003311 }
3312 break;
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003313 }
3314 return 0;
3315}
3316
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00003317
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003318/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
3319/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003320/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
3321/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003322/// insert new instructions.
3323Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003324 bool isSigned, bool Inside,
3325 Instruction &IB) {
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003326 assert(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getICmp((isSigned ?
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003327 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003328 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003329
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003330 if (Inside) {
3331 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003332 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003333
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003334 // V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003335 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003336 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003337 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
3338 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3339 }
3340
3341 // Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
3342 Constant *NegLo = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003343 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003344 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003345 Constant *UpperBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3346 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003347 }
3348
3349 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003350 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003351
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003352 // V < Min || V >= Hi -> V > Hi-1
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003353 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi));
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003354 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003355 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
3356 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
3357 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3358 }
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003359
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003360 // Emit V-Lo >u Hi-1-Lo
3361 // Note that Hi has already had one subtracted from it, above.
3362 ConstantInt *NegLo = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003363 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003364 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003365 Constant *LowerBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3366 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003367}
3368
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003369// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
3370// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
3371// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
3372// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003373static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, uint32_t &MB, uint32_t &ME) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003374 const APInt& V = Val->getValue();
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003375 uint32_t BitWidth = Val->getType()->getBitWidth();
3376 if (!APIntOps::isShiftedMask(BitWidth, V)) return false;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003377
3378 // look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003379 MB = BitWidth - ((V - 1) ^ V).countLeadingZeros();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003380 // look for the first non-zero bit
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003381 ME = V.getActiveBits();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003382 return true;
3383}
3384
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003385/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
3386/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
3387/// the following xforms:
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003388///
3389/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
3390/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3391/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3392///
3393/// return (A +/- B).
3394///
3395Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003396 ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003397 Instruction &I) {
3398 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
3399 if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
3400 !isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
3401
3402 ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
3403
3404 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
3405 default: return 0;
3406 case Instruction::And:
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003407 if (And(N, Mask) == Mask) {
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003408 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003409 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3410 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) ==
3411 Mask->getValue().getBitWidth())
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003412 break;
3413
3414 // Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
3415 // part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
3416 // is all N is, ignore it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003417 uint32_t MB = 0, ME = 0;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003418 if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00003419 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003420 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, MB-1));
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003421 if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003422 break;
3423 }
3424 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003425 return 0;
3426 case Instruction::Or:
3427 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003428 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003429 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3430 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) == Mask->getValue().getBitWidth()
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003431 && And(N, Mask)->isZero())
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003432 break;
3433 return 0;
3434 }
3435
3436 Instruction *New;
3437 if (isSub)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003438 New = BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003439 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003440 New = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003441 return InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
3442}
3443
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003444Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003445 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003446 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003447
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003448 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X & undef -> 0
3449 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3450
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003451 // and X, X = X
3452 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003453 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003454
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003455 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003456 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003457 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003458 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3459 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3460 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003461 KnownZero, KnownOne))
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003462 return &I;
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003463 } else {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003464 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003465 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X & <-1,-1> -> X
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003466 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003467 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3468 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X & <0,0> -> <0,0>
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003469 }
3470 }
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003471
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003472 if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003473 const APInt& AndRHSMask = AndRHS->getValue();
3474 APInt NotAndRHS(~AndRHSMask);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003475
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003476 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003477 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003478 Instruction *Op0I = cast<Instruction>(Op0);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003479 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
3480 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
3481 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
3482 case Instruction::Xor:
3483 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003484 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
3485 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3486 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3487 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003488 Instruction *NewRHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003489 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
3490 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003491 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003492 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003493 }
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003494 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003495 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3496 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003497 Instruction *NewLHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003498 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
3499 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003500 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003501 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
3502 }
3503 }
3504
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003505 break;
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003506 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003507 // ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3508 // ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3509 // ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3510 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003511 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003512 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003513 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003514 break;
3515
3516 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003517 // ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3518 // ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3519 // ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3520 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003521 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003522
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00003523 // (A - N) & AndRHS -> -N & AndRHS iff A&AndRHS==0 and AndRHS
3524 // has 1's for all bits that the subtraction with A might affect.
3525 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3526 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHSMask.getBitWidth();
3527 uint32_t Zeros = AndRHSMask.countLeadingZeros();
3528 APInt Mask = APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - Zeros);
3529
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003530 ConstantInt *A = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0LHS);
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00003531 if (!(A && A->isZero()) && // avoid infinite recursion.
3532 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, Mask)) {
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003533 Instruction *NewNeg = BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0RHS);
3534 InsertNewInstBefore(NewNeg, I);
3535 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewNeg, AndRHS);
3536 }
3537 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003538 break;
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00003539
3540 case Instruction::Shl:
3541 case Instruction::LShr:
3542 // (1 << x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
3543 // (1 >> x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
Nick Lewyckyd8ad4922008-07-09 07:35:26 +00003544 if (AndRHSMask == 1 && Op0LHS == AndRHS) {
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00003545 Instruction *NewICmp = new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0RHS,
3546 Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3547 InsertNewInstBefore(NewICmp, I);
3548 return new ZExtInst(NewICmp, I.getType());
3549 }
3550 break;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003551 }
3552
Chris Lattner58403262003-07-23 19:25:52 +00003553 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003554 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003555 return Res;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003556 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003557 // If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
3558 // if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
3559 // frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
3560 if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003561 if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003562 CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003563 if (ConstantInt *AndCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003564 if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
3565 // Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003566 // into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
3567 // This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
3568 // other simplifications.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003569 Instruction *NewCast = CastInst::CreateTruncOrBitCast(
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003570 CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
3571 CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003572 NewCast = InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003573 // trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003574 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003575 C3 = ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003576 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewCast, C3);
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003577 } else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
3578 // Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
3579 // into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
Chris Lattnerbb4e7b22006-12-12 19:11:20 +00003580 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003581 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS) // trunc(C1)&C2
3582 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
3583 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003584 }
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003585 }
Chris Lattner06782f82003-07-23 19:36:21 +00003586 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003587
3588 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3589 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003590 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003591 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003592 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3593 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3594 return NV;
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003595 }
3596
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003597 Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0);
3598 Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003599
Chris Lattner5b62aa72004-06-18 06:07:51 +00003600 if (Op0NotVal == Op1 || Op1NotVal == Op0) // A & ~A == ~A & A == 0
3601 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3602
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003603 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003604 if (Op0NotVal && Op1NotVal && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003605 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003606 I.getName()+".demorgan");
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003607 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003608 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Or);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003609 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003610
3611 {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003612 Value *A = 0, *B = 0, *C = 0, *D = 0;
3613 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003614 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A | ?) & A --> A
3615 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003616
3617 // (A|B) & ~(A&B) -> A^B
3618 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3619 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003620 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003621 }
3622 }
3623
3624 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003625 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A & (A | ?) --> A
3626 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003627
3628 // ~(A&B) & (A|B) -> A^B
3629 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3630 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003631 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003632 }
3633 }
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003634
3635 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
3636 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3637 if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
3638 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3639 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3640 } else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
3641 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
3642 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3643 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3644 }
3645 }
3646 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
3647 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3648 if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
3649 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
3650 std::swap(A, B);
3651 }
3652 if (A == Op0) { // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003653 Instruction *NotB = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(B, "tmp");
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003654 InsertNewInstBefore(NotB, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003655 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003656 }
3657 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003658 }
3659
Nick Lewyckyb30591e2008-08-06 04:54:03 +00003660 { // (icmp ult A, C) & (icmp ult B, C) --> (icmp ult (A|B), C)
3661 // where C is a power of 2
3662 Value *A, *B;
3663 ConstantInt *C1, *C2;
Evan Chengab5d5e32008-08-20 23:36:48 +00003664 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC = ICmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
3665 ICmpInst::Predicate RHSCC = ICmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
Nick Lewyckyb30591e2008-08-06 04:54:03 +00003666 if (match(&I, m_And(m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1)),
3667 m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(B), m_ConstantInt(C2)))))
3668 if (C1 == C2 && LHSCC == RHSCC && LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT &&
3669 C1->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
3670 Instruction *NewOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, B);
3671 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOr, I);
3672 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, NewOr, C1);
3673 }
3674 }
3675
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003676 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
3677 // (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3678 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003679 return R;
3680
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003681 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
3682 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003683 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3684 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
3685 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3686 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) & (X icmp C2)
3687 // ICMP_[GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[GL]T elsewhere.
3688 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3689 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3690 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
Chris Lattnereec8b9a2007-11-22 23:47:13 +00003691 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3692
3693 // Don't try to fold ICMP_SLT + ICMP_ULT.
3694 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) || ICmpInst::isEquality(RHSCC) ||
3695 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ==
3696 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC))) {
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003697 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Chris Lattneree2b7a42008-01-13 20:59:02 +00003698 ICmpInst::Predicate GT;
3699 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ||
3700 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) &&
3701 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)))
3702 GT = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
3703 else
3704 GT = ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
3705
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003706 Constant *Cmp = ConstantExpr::getICmp(GT, LHSCst, RHSCst);
3707 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003708 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Cmp)->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003709 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3710 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3711 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3712 }
3713
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003714 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003715 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
3716 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003717 // icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
3718 // (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
3719 // are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003720 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3721
3722 switch (LHSCC) {
3723 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003724 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003725 switch (RHSCC) {
3726 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003727 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
3728 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3729 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003730 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003731 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
3732 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3733 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003734 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3735 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003736 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003737 switch (RHSCC) {
3738 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003739 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3740 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
3741 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3742 break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3743 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3744 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
3745 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3746 break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3747 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3748 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3749 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003750 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003751 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3752 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003753 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003754 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003755 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
3756 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Chris Lattner424db022007-01-27 23:08:34 +00003757 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
3758 ConstantInt::get(Add->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003759 }
3760 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3761 }
3762 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003763 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003764 switch (RHSCC) {
3765 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003766 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3767 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003768 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003769 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3770 break;
3771 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
3772 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003773 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003774 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3775 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003776 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003777 break;
3778 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003779 switch (RHSCC) {
3780 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003781 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3782 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003783 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003784 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3785 break;
3786 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
3787 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003788 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003789 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3790 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003791 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003792 break;
3793 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3794 switch (RHSCC) {
3795 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Eli Friedman5c1f1722008-06-21 23:36:13 +00003796 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003797 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3798 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3799 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3800 break;
3801 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3802 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
3803 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3804 break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3805 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) ->(X-14) <u 1
3806 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, false,
3807 true, I);
3808 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3809 break;
3810 }
3811 break;
3812 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3813 switch (RHSCC) {
3814 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattnera7d1ab02007-11-16 06:04:17 +00003815 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003816 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3817 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3818 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3819 break;
3820 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3821 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
3822 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3823 break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3824 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) ->(X-14) s< 1
3825 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, true,
3826 true, I);
3827 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3828 break;
3829 }
3830 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003831 }
3832 }
3833 }
3834
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003835 // fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003836 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
3837 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
3838 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
3839 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003840 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003841 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003842 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
3843 I.getType(), TD) &&
3844 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
3845 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003846 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003847 Op1C->getOperand(0),
3848 I.getName());
3849 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003850 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003851 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003852 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003853
3854 // (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003855 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3856 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3857 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003858 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3859 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3860 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003861 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(SI0->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003862 SI1->getOperand(0),
3863 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003864 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003865 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003866 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003867 }
3868
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003869 // (fcmp ord x, c) & (fcmp ord y, c) -> (fcmp ord x, y)
3870 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
3871 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
3872 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD &&
3873 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD)
3874 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
3875 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
3876 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
3877 // false.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00003878 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00003879 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
3880 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS->getOperand(0),
3881 RHS->getOperand(0));
3882 }
3883 }
3884 }
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003885
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003886 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003887}
3888
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003889/// CollectBSwapParts - Look to see if the specified value defines a single byte
3890/// in the result. If it does, and if the specified byte hasn't been filled in
3891/// yet, fill it in and return false.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00003892static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, SmallVector<Value*, 8> &ByteValues) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003893 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
3894 if (I == 0) return true;
3895
3896 // If this is an or instruction, it is an inner node of the bswap.
3897 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or)
3898 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), ByteValues) ||
3899 CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), ByteValues);
3900
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003901 uint32_t BitWidth = I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003902 // If this is a shift by a constant int, and it is "24", then its operand
3903 // defines a byte. We only handle unsigned types here.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003904 if (I->isShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003905 // Not shifting the entire input by N-1 bytes?
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003906 if (cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) !=
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003907 8*(ByteValues.size()-1))
3908 return true;
3909
3910 unsigned DestNo;
3911 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
3912 // X << 24 defines the top byte with the lowest of the input bytes.
3913 DestNo = ByteValues.size()-1;
3914 } else {
3915 // X >>u 24 defines the low byte with the highest of the input bytes.
3916 DestNo = 0;
3917 }
3918
3919 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
3920 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
3921 if (ByteValues[DestNo] && ByteValues[DestNo] != I->getOperand(0))
3922 return true;
3923 ByteValues[DestNo] = I->getOperand(0);
3924 return false;
3925 }
3926
3927 // Otherwise, we can only handle and(shift X, imm), imm). Bail out of if we
3928 // don't have this.
3929 Value *Shift = 0, *ShiftLHS = 0;
3930 ConstantInt *AndAmt = 0, *ShiftAmt = 0;
3931 if (!match(I, m_And(m_Value(Shift), m_ConstantInt(AndAmt))) ||
3932 !match(Shift, m_Shift(m_Value(ShiftLHS), m_ConstantInt(ShiftAmt))))
3933 return true;
3934 Instruction *SI = cast<Instruction>(Shift);
3935
3936 // Make sure that the shift amount is by a multiple of 8 and isn't too big.
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003937 if (ShiftAmt->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) & 7 ||
3938 ShiftAmt->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) > 8*ByteValues.size())
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003939 return true;
3940
3941 // Turn 0xFF -> 0, 0xFF00 -> 1, 0xFF0000 -> 2, etc.
3942 unsigned DestByte;
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003943 if (AndAmt->getValue().getActiveBits() > 64)
3944 return true;
3945 uint64_t AndAmtVal = AndAmt->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003946 for (DestByte = 0; DestByte != ByteValues.size(); ++DestByte)
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003947 if (AndAmtVal == uint64_t(0xFF) << 8*DestByte)
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003948 break;
3949 // Unknown mask for bswap.
3950 if (DestByte == ByteValues.size()) return true;
3951
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003952 unsigned ShiftBytes = ShiftAmt->getZExtValue()/8;
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003953 unsigned SrcByte;
3954 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
3955 SrcByte = DestByte - ShiftBytes;
3956 else
3957 SrcByte = DestByte + ShiftBytes;
3958
3959 // If the SrcByte isn't a bswapped value from the DestByte, reject it.
3960 if (SrcByte != ByteValues.size()-DestByte-1)
3961 return true;
3962
3963 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
3964 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
3965 if (ByteValues[DestByte] && ByteValues[DestByte] != SI->getOperand(0))
3966 return true;
3967 ByteValues[DestByte] = SI->getOperand(0);
3968 return false;
3969}
3970
3971/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
3972/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
3973Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00003974 const IntegerType *ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
3975 if (!ITy || ITy->getBitWidth() % 16)
3976 return 0; // Can only bswap pairs of bytes. Can't do vectors.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003977
3978 /// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
3979 /// defines each byte.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00003980 SmallVector<Value*, 8> ByteValues;
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00003981 ByteValues.resize(ITy->getBitWidth()/8);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003982
3983 // Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
3984 if (CollectBSwapParts(I.getOperand(0), ByteValues) ||
3985 CollectBSwapParts(I.getOperand(1), ByteValues))
3986 return 0;
3987
3988 // Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
3989 Value *V = ByteValues[0];
3990 if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
3991
3992 // Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
3993 for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
3994 if (ByteValues[i] != V)
3995 return 0;
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00003996 const Type *Tys[] = { ITy };
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003997 Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00003998 Function *F = Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, Intrinsic::bswap, Tys, 1);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00003999 return CallInst::Create(F, V);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004000}
4001
4002
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004003Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004004 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004005 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004006
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004007 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X | undef -> -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004008 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004009
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004010 // or X, X = X
4011 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004012 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004013
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004014 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4015 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004016 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4017 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4018 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4019 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4020 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4021 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004022 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4023 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X | <0,0> -> X
4024 } else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
4025 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X | <-1,-1> -> <-1,-1>
4026 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004027 }
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004028
4029
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004030
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004031 // or X, -1 == -1
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004032 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00004033 ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004034 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
4035 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004036 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004037 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004038 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004039 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004040 ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() | C1->getValue()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004041 }
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004042
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004043 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
4044 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004045 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004046 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004047 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004048 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004049 ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & ~RHS->getValue()));
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004050 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004051
4052 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4053 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004054 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004055 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004056 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4057 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4058 return NV;
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004059 }
4060
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00004061 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
4062 ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004063
4064 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
4065 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A & ?) | A --> A
4066 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4067 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
4068 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A | (A & ?) --> A
4069 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4070
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00004071 // (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
4072 // (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004073 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00004074 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
4075 (match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())) &&
4076 match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004077 if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
4078 return BSwap;
4079 }
4080
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004081 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
4082 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004083 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004084 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op1);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004085 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
4086 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004087 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004088 }
4089
4090 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
4091 if (Op1->hasOneUse() && match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004092 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004093 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op0);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004094 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
4095 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004096 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004097 }
4098
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004099 // (A & C)|(B & D)
Chris Lattner2384d7b2007-06-19 05:43:49 +00004100 Value *C = 0, *D = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004101 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(C))) &&
4102 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004103 Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0, *V3 = 0;
4104 C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
4105 C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D);
4106 if (C1 && C2) { // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
4107 // If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
4108 // .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
4109 // replace with V+N.
4110 if (C1->getValue() == ~C2->getValue()) {
4111 if ((C2->getValue() & (C2->getValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
4112 match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
4113 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4114 if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getValue()))
4115 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4116 if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getValue()))
4117 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4118 }
4119 // Or commutes, try both ways.
4120 if ((C1->getValue() & (C1->getValue()+1)) == 0 &&
4121 match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
4122 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4123 if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getValue()))
4124 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4125 if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getValue()))
4126 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4127 }
4128 }
Chris Lattner044e5332007-04-08 08:01:49 +00004129 V1 = 0; V2 = 0; V3 = 0;
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004130 }
4131
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004132 // Check to see if we have any common things being and'ed. If so, find the
4133 // terms for V1 & (V2|V3).
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004134 if (isOnlyUse(Op0) || isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
4135 if (A == B) // (A & C)|(A & D) == A & (C|D)
4136 V1 = A, V2 = C, V3 = D;
4137 else if (A == D) // (A & C)|(B & A) == A & (B|C)
4138 V1 = A, V2 = B, V3 = C;
4139 else if (C == B) // (A & C)|(C & D) == C & (A|D)
4140 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = D;
4141 else if (C == D) // (A & C)|(B & C) == C & (A|B)
4142 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = B;
4143
4144 if (V1) {
4145 Value *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004146 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(V2, V3, "tmp"), I);
4147 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, Or);
Chris Lattner0b7c0bf2005-09-18 06:02:59 +00004148 }
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004149 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004150 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004151
4152 // (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004153 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
4154 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
4155 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004156 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
4157 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
4158 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004159 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(SI0->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004160 SI1->getOperand(0),
4161 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004162 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004163 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004164 }
4165 }
Chris Lattner67ca7682003-08-12 19:11:07 +00004166
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004167 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)))) { // ~A | Op1
4168 if (A == Op1) // ~A | A == -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004169 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004170 } else {
4171 A = 0;
4172 }
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004173 // Note, A is still live here!
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004174 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)))) { // Op0 | ~B
4175 if (Op0 == B)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004176 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004177
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00004178 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004179 if (A && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004180 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, B,
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004181 I.getName()+".demorgan"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004182 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(And);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004183 }
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004184 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004185
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004186 // (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4187 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4188 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004189 return R;
4190
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004191 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
4192 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004193 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
4194 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
4195 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
4196 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) | (X icmp C2)
4197 // icmp [us][gl]e x, cst is folded to icmp [us][gl]t elsewhere.
4198 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
4199 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
4200 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004201 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
4202 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) | (sgt x, C2).
4203 PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004204 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004205 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004206 bool NeedsSwap;
4207 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC))
Chris Lattner3aea1bd2007-05-11 16:58:45 +00004208 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004209 else
Chris Lattner3aea1bd2007-05-11 16:58:45 +00004210 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00004211
4212 if (NeedsSwap) {
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004213 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
4214 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
4215 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
4216 }
4217
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004218 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004219 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
4220 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004221 // ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
4222 // FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004223 // equal.
4224 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
4225
4226 switch (LHSCC) {
4227 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004228 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004229 switch (RHSCC) {
4230 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004231 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004232 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) {// (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
4233 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004234 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004235 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
4236 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004237 AddCST = Subtract(AddOne(RHSCst), LHSCst);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004238 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004239 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004240 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
4241 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
4242 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
Chris Lattner240d6f42005-04-19 06:04:18 +00004243 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004244 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4245 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4246 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004247 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4248 }
4249 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004250 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004251 switch (RHSCC) {
4252 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004253 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
4254 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
4255 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004256 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004257 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
4258 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
4259 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004260 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004261 }
4262 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004263 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004264 switch (RHSCC) {
4265 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004266 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004267 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004268 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) ->(X-13) u> 2
Chris Lattner74e012a2007-11-01 02:18:41 +00004269 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4270 // this can cause overflow.
4271 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(false))
4272 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004273 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), false,
4274 false, I);
4275 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4276 break;
4277 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4278 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004279 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004280 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4281 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004282 }
4283 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004284 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004285 switch (RHSCC) {
4286 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004287 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4288 break;
4289 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) ->(X-13) s> 2
Chris Lattner74e012a2007-11-01 02:18:41 +00004290 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4291 // this can cause overflow.
4292 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(true))
4293 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004294 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), true,
4295 false, I);
4296 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4297 break;
4298 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4299 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4300 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4301 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4302 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004303 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004304 break;
4305 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4306 switch (RHSCC) {
4307 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4308 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
4309 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
4310 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4311 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4312 break;
4313 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4314 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004315 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004316 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4317 break;
4318 }
4319 break;
4320 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4321 switch (RHSCC) {
4322 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4323 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
4324 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
4325 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4326 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4327 break;
4328 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4329 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004330 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004331 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4332 break;
4333 }
4334 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004335 }
4336 }
4337 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004338
4339 // fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004340 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004341 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004342 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004343 if (!isa<ICmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0)) ||
4344 !isa<ICmpInst>(Op1C->getOperand(0))) {
4345 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
4346 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
4347 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be
4348 // generated.
4349 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4350 I.getType(), TD) &&
4351 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4352 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004353 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004354 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4355 I.getName());
4356 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004357 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004358 }
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004359 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004360 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004361 }
4362
4363
4364 // (fcmp uno x, c) | (fcmp uno y, c) -> (fcmp uno x, y)
4365 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
4366 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4367 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
Chris Lattner5ebd9362008-02-29 06:09:11 +00004368 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
4369 LHS->getOperand(0)->getType() == RHS->getOperand(0)->getType())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004370 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
4371 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
4372 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
4373 // true.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00004374 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004375 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4376
4377 // Otherwise, no need to compare the two constants, compare the
4378 // rest.
4379 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS->getOperand(0),
4380 RHS->getOperand(0));
4381 }
4382 }
4383 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004384
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004385 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004386}
4387
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004388namespace {
4389
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004390// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
4391struct XorSelf {
4392 Value *RHS;
4393 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
4394 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
4395 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
4396 return &Xor;
4397 }
4398};
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004399
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004400}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004401
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004402Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004403 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004404 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004405
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00004406 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
4407 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
4408 // Handle undef ^ undef -> 0 special case. This is a common
4409 // idiom (misuse).
4410 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004411 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00004412 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004413
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004414 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
4415 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00004416 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?"); Result=Result;
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004417 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004418 }
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004419
4420 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4421 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004422 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4423 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4424 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4425 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4426 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4427 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004428 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4429 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X ^ <0,0> -> X
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004430 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004431
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004432 // Is this a ~ operation?
4433 if (Value *NotOp = dyn_castNotVal(&I)) {
4434 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4435 // ~(~X | Y) === (X & ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4436 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NotOp)) {
4437 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
4438 Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4439 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1))) Op0I->swapOperands();
4440 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
4441 Instruction *NotY =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004442 BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0I->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004443 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
4444 InsertNewInstBefore(NotY, I);
4445 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004446 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004447 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004448 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004449 }
4450 }
4451 }
4452 }
4453
4454
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004455 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004456 // xor (cmp A, B), true = not (cmp A, B) = !cmp A, B
4457 if (RHS == ConstantInt::getTrue() && Op0->hasOneUse()) {
4458 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004459 return new ICmpInst(ICI->getInversePredicate(),
4460 ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerad5b4fb2003-11-04 23:50:51 +00004461
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004462 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(Op0))
4463 return new FCmpInst(FCI->getInversePredicate(),
4464 FCI->getOperand(0), FCI->getOperand(1));
4465 }
4466
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00004467 // fold (xor(zext(cmp)), 1) and (xor(sext(cmp)), -1) to ext(!cmp).
4468 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
4469 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0))) {
4470 if (CI->hasOneUse() && Op0C->hasOneUse()) {
4471 Instruction::CastOps Opcode = Op0C->getOpcode();
4472 if (Opcode == Instruction::ZExt || Opcode == Instruction::SExt) {
4473 if (RHS == ConstantExpr::getCast(Opcode, ConstantInt::getTrue(),
4474 Op0C->getDestTy())) {
4475 Instruction *NewCI = InsertNewInstBefore(CmpInst::Create(
4476 CI->getOpcode(), CI->getInversePredicate(),
4477 CI->getOperand(0), CI->getOperand(1)), I);
4478 NewCI->takeName(CI);
4479 return CastInst::Create(Opcode, NewCI, Op0C->getType());
4480 }
4481 }
4482 }
4483 }
4484 }
4485
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004486 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00004487 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004488 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
4489 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004490 Constant *NegOp0I0C = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0I0C);
4491 Constant *ConstantRHS = ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0I0C,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004492 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004493 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004494 }
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004495
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004496 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004497 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004498 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004499 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004500 Constant *NegOp0CI = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004501 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004502 ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0CI,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004503 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)),
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004504 Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattneracf4e072007-04-02 05:42:22 +00004505 } else if (RHS->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004506 // (X + C) ^ signbit -> (X + C + signbit)
4507 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() + Op0CI->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004508 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(0), C);
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00004509
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004510 }
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004511 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4512 // (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004513 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004514 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getOr(Op0CI, RHS);
4515 // Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
4516 // NewRHS.
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004517 Constant *CommonBits = And(Op0CI, RHS);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004518 NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getAnd(NewRHS,
4519 ConstantExpr::getNot(CommonBits));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00004520 AddToWorkList(Op0I);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004521 I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
4522 I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
4523 return &I;
4524 }
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004525 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004526 }
Chris Lattner05bd1b22002-08-20 18:24:26 +00004527 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004528
4529 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4530 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004531 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004532 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004533 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4534 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4535 return NV;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004536 }
4537
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004538 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0)) // ~A ^ A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004539 if (X == Op1)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004540 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004541
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004542 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1)) // A ^ ~A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004543 if (X == Op0)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004544 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004545
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004546
4547 BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
4548 if (Op1I) {
4549 Value *A, *B;
4550 if (match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4551 if (A == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004552 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004553 I.swapOperands();
4554 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004555 } else if (B == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004556 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004557 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004558 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004559 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4560 if (Op0 == A) // A^(A^B) == B
4561 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4562 else if (Op0 == B) // A^(B^A) == B
4563 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4564 } else if (match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op1I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004565 if (A == Op0) { // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004566 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004567 std::swap(A, B);
4568 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004569 if (B == Op0) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004570 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
4571 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4572 }
Chris Lattner26ca7e12004-02-16 03:54:20 +00004573 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004574 }
4575
4576 BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
4577 if (Op0I) {
4578 Value *A, *B;
4579 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4580 if (A == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
4581 std::swap(A, B);
4582 if (B == Op1) { // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
4583 Instruction *NotB =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004584 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, "tmp"), I);
4585 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004586 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004587 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4588 if (Op1 == A) // (A^B)^A == B
4589 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4590 else if (Op1 == B) // (B^A)^A == B
4591 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4592 } else if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()){
4593 if (A == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
4594 std::swap(A, B);
4595 if (B == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
Chris Lattnerae1ab392006-04-01 22:05:01 +00004596 !isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004597 Instruction *N =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004598 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(A, "tmp"), I);
4599 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(N, Op1);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004600 }
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004601 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004602 }
4603
4604 // (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
4605 if (Op0I && Op1I && Op0I->isShift() &&
4606 Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() &&
4607 Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
4608 (Op1I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse())) {
4609 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004610 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004611 Op1I->getOperand(0),
4612 Op0I->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004613 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op1I->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004614 Op1I->getOperand(1));
4615 }
4616
4617 if (Op0I && Op1I) {
4618 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
4619 // (A & B)^(A | B) -> A ^ B
4620 if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4621 match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4622 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004623 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004624 }
4625 // (A | B)^(A & B) -> A ^ B
4626 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4627 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4628 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004629 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004630 }
4631
4632 // (A & B)^(C & D)
4633 if ((Op0I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse()) &&
4634 match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4635 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4636 // (X & Y)^(X & Y) -> (Y^Z) & X
4637 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
4638 if (A == C)
4639 X = A, Y = B, Z = D;
4640 else if (A == D)
4641 X = A, Y = B, Z = C;
4642 else if (B == C)
4643 X = B, Y = A, Z = D;
4644 else if (B == D)
4645 X = B, Y = A, Z = C;
4646
4647 if (X) {
4648 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004649 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Y, Z, Op0->getName()), I);
4650 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewOp, X);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004651 }
4652 }
4653 }
4654
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004655 // (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4656 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
4657 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004658 return R;
4659
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004660 // fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004661 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004662 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004663 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
4664 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00004665 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004666 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004667 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4668 I.getType(), TD) &&
4669 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4670 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004671 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004672 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4673 I.getName());
4674 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004675 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004676 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004677 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004678 }
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00004679
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004680 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004681}
4682
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004683/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
4684/// overflowed for this type.
4685static bool AddWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004686 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004687 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(Add(In1, In2));
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004688
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004689 if (IsSigned)
4690 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
4691 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
4692 else
4693 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
4694 else
4695 return Result->getValue().ult(In1->getValue());
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004696}
4697
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004698/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
4699/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
4700/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
4701static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, Instruction &I, InstCombiner &IC) {
4702 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
4703 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004704 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
4705 Value *Result = Constant::getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004706
4707 // Build a mask for high order bits.
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004708 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004709 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004710
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00004711 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP->op_begin() + 1, e = GEP->op_end(); i != e;
4712 ++i, ++GTI) {
4713 Value *Op = *i;
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00004714 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004715 if (ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op)) {
4716 if (OpC->isZero()) continue;
4717
4718 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
4719 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
4720 Size = TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(OpC->getZExtValue());
4721
4722 if (ConstantInt *RC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Result))
4723 Result = ConstantInt::get(RC->getValue() + APInt(IntPtrWidth, Size));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004724 else
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004725 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004726 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004727 ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size),
4728 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
4729 continue;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004730 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004731
4732 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
4733 Constant *OC = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
4734 Scale = ConstantExpr::getMul(OC, Scale);
4735 if (Constant *RC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
4736 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(RC, Scale);
4737 else {
4738 // Emit an add instruction.
4739 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004740 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result, Scale,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004741 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004742 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004743 continue;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004744 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004745 // Convert to correct type.
4746 if (Op->getType() != IntPtrTy) {
4747 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
4748 Op = ConstantExpr::getSExt(OpC, IntPtrTy);
4749 else
4750 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new SExtInst(Op, IntPtrTy,
4751 Op->getName()+".c"), I);
4752 }
4753 if (Size != 1) {
4754 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
4755 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
4756 Op = ConstantExpr::getMul(OpC, Scale);
4757 else // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004758 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op, Scale,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004759 GEP->getName()+".idx"), I);
4760 }
4761
4762 // Emit an add instruction.
4763 if (isa<Constant>(Op) && isa<Constant>(Result))
4764 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(Op),
4765 cast<Constant>(Result));
4766 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004767 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op, Result,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004768 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004769 }
4770 return Result;
4771}
4772
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004773
4774/// EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression - Return an value that can be used to compare of
4775/// the *offset* implied by GEP to zero. For example, if we have &A[i], we want
4776/// to return 'i' for "icmp ne i, 0". Note that, in general, indices can be
4777/// complex, and scales are involved. The above expression would also be legal
4778/// to codegen as "icmp ne (i*4), 0" (assuming A is a pointer to i32). This
4779/// later form is less amenable to optimization though, and we are allowed to
4780/// generate the first by knowing that pointer arithmetic doesn't overflow.
4781///
4782/// If we can't emit an optimized form for this expression, this returns null.
4783///
4784static Value *EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(User *GEP, Instruction &I,
4785 InstCombiner &IC) {
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004786 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
4787 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
4788
4789 // Check to see if this gep only has a single variable index. If so, and if
4790 // any constant indices are a multiple of its scale, then we can compute this
4791 // in terms of the scale of the variable index. For example, if the GEP
4792 // implies an offset of "12 + i*4", then we can codegen this as "3 + i",
4793 // because the expression will cross zero at the same point.
4794 unsigned i, e = GEP->getNumOperands();
4795 int64_t Offset = 0;
4796 for (i = 1; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
4797 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i))) {
4798 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
4799 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
4800
4801 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
4802 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
4803 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
4804 } else {
4805 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
4806 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
4807 }
4808 } else {
4809 // Found our variable index.
4810 break;
4811 }
4812 }
4813
4814 // If there are no variable indices, we must have a constant offset, just
4815 // evaluate it the general way.
4816 if (i == e) return 0;
4817
4818 Value *VariableIdx = GEP->getOperand(i);
4819 // Determine the scale factor of the variable element. For example, this is
4820 // 4 if the variable index is into an array of i32.
4821 uint64_t VariableScale = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
4822
4823 // Verify that there are no other variable indices. If so, emit the hard way.
4824 for (++i, ++GTI; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
4825 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i));
4826 if (!CI) return 0;
4827
4828 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
4829 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
4830
4831 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
4832 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
4833 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
4834 } else {
4835 uint64_t Size = TD.getABITypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
4836 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
4837 }
4838 }
4839
4840 // Okay, we know we have a single variable index, which must be a
4841 // pointer/array/vector index. If there is no offset, life is simple, return
4842 // the index.
4843 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
4844 if (Offset == 0) {
4845 // Cast to intptrty in case a truncation occurs. If an extension is needed,
4846 // we don't need to bother extending: the extension won't affect where the
4847 // computation crosses zero.
4848 if (VariableIdx->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() > IntPtrWidth)
4849 VariableIdx = new TruncInst(VariableIdx, TD.getIntPtrType(),
4850 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
4851 return VariableIdx;
4852 }
4853
4854 // Otherwise, there is an index. The computation we will do will be modulo
4855 // the pointer size, so get it.
4856 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
4857
4858 Offset &= PtrSizeMask;
4859 VariableScale &= PtrSizeMask;
4860
4861 // To do this transformation, any constant index must be a multiple of the
4862 // variable scale factor. For example, we can evaluate "12 + 4*i" as "3 + i",
4863 // but we can't evaluate "10 + 3*i" in terms of i. Check that the offset is a
4864 // multiple of the variable scale.
4865 int64_t NewOffs = Offset / (int64_t)VariableScale;
4866 if (Offset != NewOffs*(int64_t)VariableScale)
4867 return 0;
4868
4869 // Okay, we can do this evaluation. Start by converting the index to intptr.
4870 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
4871 if (VariableIdx->getType() != IntPtrTy)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004872 VariableIdx = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(VariableIdx, IntPtrTy,
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004873 true /*SExt*/,
4874 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
4875 Constant *OffsetVal = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, NewOffs);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004876 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(VariableIdx, OffsetVal, "offset", &I);
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004877}
4878
4879
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004880/// FoldGEPICmp - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004881/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004882Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
4883 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond,
4884 Instruction &I) {
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004885 assert(dyn_castGetElementPtr(GEPLHS) && "LHS is not a getelementptr!");
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004886
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004887 // Look through bitcasts.
4888 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(RHS))
4889 RHS = BCI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004890
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004891 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
4892 if (PtrBase == RHS) {
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00004893 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00004894 // This transformation (ignoring the base and scales) is valid because we
4895 // know pointers can't overflow. See if we can output an optimized form.
4896 Value *Offset = EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(GEPLHS, I, *this);
4897
4898 // If not, synthesize the offset the hard way.
4899 if (Offset == 0)
4900 Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00004901 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), Offset,
4902 Constant::getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004903 } else if (User *GEPRHS = dyn_castGetElementPtr(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004904 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
4905 // compare the base pointer.
4906 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
4907 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00004908 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
Chris Lattner93b94a62005-04-26 14:40:41 +00004909 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004910 if (IndicesTheSame)
4911 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4912 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
4913 IndicesTheSame = false;
4914 break;
4915 }
4916
4917 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
4918 if (IndicesTheSame)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004919 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond),
4920 GEPLHS->getOperand(0), GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004921
4922 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
4923 // different, bail out.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004924 return 0;
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004925 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004926
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004927 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
4928 bool AllZeros = true;
4929 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4930 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
4931 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4932 AllZeros = false;
4933 break;
4934 }
4935 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004936 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
4937 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Cond), I);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004938
4939 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004940 AllZeros = true;
4941 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4942 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
4943 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4944 AllZeros = false;
4945 break;
4946 }
4947 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004948 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004949
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004950 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
4951 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
4952 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
4953 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
4954 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4955 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00004956 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
4957 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00004958 // Irreconcilable differences.
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004959 NumDifferences = 2;
4960 break;
4961 } else {
4962 if (NumDifferences++) break;
4963 DiffOperand = i;
4964 }
4965 }
4966
4967 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
4968 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00004969 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00004970 ICmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(Cond)));
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00004971
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004972 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00004973 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
4974 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004975 // Make sure we do a signed comparison here.
4976 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), LHSV, RHSV);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004977 }
4978 }
4979
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004980 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004981 // the result to fold to a constant!
4982 if ((isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
4983 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
4984 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
4985 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
4986 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004987 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), L, R);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004988 }
4989 }
4990 return 0;
4991}
4992
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00004993/// FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst - Fold fcmp ([us]itofp x, cst) if possible.
4994///
4995Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I,
4996 Instruction *LHSI,
4997 Constant *RHSC) {
4998 if (!isa<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) return 0;
4999 const APFloat &RHS = cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)->getValueAPF();
5000
5001 // Get the width of the mantissa. We don't want to hack on conversions that
5002 // might lose information from the integer, e.g. "i64 -> float"
Chris Lattner7be1c452008-05-19 21:17:23 +00005003 int MantissaWidth = LHSI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005004 if (MantissaWidth == -1) return 0; // Unknown.
5005
5006 // Check to see that the input is converted from an integer type that is small
5007 // enough that preserves all bits. TODO: check here for "known" sign bits.
5008 // This would allow us to handle (fptosi (x >>s 62) to float) if x is i64 f.e.
5009 unsigned InputSize = LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5010
5011 // If this is a uitofp instruction, we need an extra bit to hold the sign.
5012 if (isa<UIToFPInst>(LHSI))
5013 ++InputSize;
5014
5015 // If the conversion would lose info, don't hack on this.
5016 if ((int)InputSize > MantissaWidth)
5017 return 0;
5018
5019 // Otherwise, we can potentially simplify the comparison. We know that it
5020 // will always come through as an integer value and we know the constant is
5021 // not a NAN (it would have been previously simplified).
5022 assert(!RHS.isNaN() && "NaN comparison not already folded!");
5023
5024 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred;
5025 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5026 default: assert(0 && "Unexpected predicate!");
5027 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ:
5028 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ; break;
5029 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT:
5030 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT; break;
5031 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE:
5032 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE; break;
5033 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT:
5034 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT; break;
5035 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE:
5036 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE; break;
5037 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE:
5038 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_NE; break;
5039 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD:
5040 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5041 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO:
5042 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5043 }
5044
5045 const IntegerType *IntTy = cast<IntegerType>(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType());
5046
5047 // Now we know that the APFloat is a normal number, zero or inf.
5048
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005049 // See if the FP constant is too large for the integer. For example,
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005050 // comparing an i8 to 300.0.
5051 unsigned IntWidth = IntTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5052
5053 // If the RHS value is > SignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles +INF
5054 // and large values.
5055 APFloat SMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5056 SMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMaxValue(IntWidth), true,
5057 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5058 if (SMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // smax < 13123.0
Chris Lattner393f7eb2008-05-24 04:06:28 +00005059 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT ||
5060 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005061 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5062 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5063 }
5064
5065 // See if the RHS value is < SignedMin.
5066 APFloat SMin(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5067 SMin.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMinValue(IntWidth), true,
5068 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5069 if (SMin.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpGreaterThan) { // smin > 12312.0
Chris Lattner393f7eb2008-05-24 04:06:28 +00005070 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT ||
5071 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE)
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005072 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5073 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5074 }
5075
5076 // Okay, now we know that the FP constant fits in the range [SMIN, SMAX] but
5077 // it may still be fractional. See if it is fractional by casting the FP
5078 // value to the integer value and back, checking for equality. Don't do this
5079 // for zero, because -0.0 is not fractional.
5080 Constant *RHSInt = ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(RHSC, IntTy);
5081 if (!RHS.isZero() &&
5082 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(RHSInt, RHSC->getType()) != RHSC) {
5083 // If we had a comparison against a fractional value, we have to adjust
5084 // the compare predicate and sometimes the value. RHSC is rounded towards
5085 // zero at this point.
5086 switch (Pred) {
5087 default: assert(0 && "Unexpected integer comparison!");
5088 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (float)int != 4.4 --> true
5089 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5090 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (float)int == 4.4 --> false
5091 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5092 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5093 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
5094 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> int < -4
5095 if (RHS.isNegative())
5096 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5097 break;
5098 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
5099 // (float)int < -4.4 --> int < -4
5100 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5101 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5102 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5103 break;
5104 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5105 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5106 // (float)int > -4.4 --> int >= -4
5107 if (RHS.isNegative())
5108 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5109 break;
5110 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5111 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> int >= -4
5112 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
5113 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5114 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5115 break;
5116 }
5117 }
5118
5119 // Lower this FP comparison into an appropriate integer version of the
5120 // comparison.
5121 return new ICmpInst(Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0), RHSInt);
5122}
5123
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005124Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I) {
5125 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005126 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005127
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005128 // Fold trivial predicates.
5129 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
5130 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int1Ty));
5131 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
5132 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5133
5134 // Simplify 'fcmp pred X, X'
5135 if (Op0 == Op1) {
5136 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5137 default: assert(0 && "Unknown predicate!");
5138 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: // True if unordered or equal
5139 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: // True if unordered, greater than, or equal
5140 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: // True if unordered, less than, or equal
5141 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
5142 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: // True if ordered and greater than
5143 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: // True if ordered and less than
5144 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: // True if ordered and operands are unequal
5145 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
5146
5147 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: // True if unordered: isnan(X) | isnan(Y)
5148 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: // True if unordered or less than
5149 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: // True if unordered or greater than
5150 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: // True if unordered or not equal
5151 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp uno %X, 0.0'.
5152 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO);
5153 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5154 return &I;
5155
5156 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: // True if ordered (no nans)
5157 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: // True if ordered and equal
5158 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: // True if ordered and greater than or equal
5159 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: // True if ordered and less than or equal
5160 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp ord %X, 0.0'.
5161 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD);
5162 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5163 return &I;
5164 }
5165 }
5166
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005167 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // fcmp pred X, undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005168 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005169
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005170 // Handle fcmp with constant RHS
5171 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005172 // If the constant is a nan, see if we can fold the comparison based on it.
5173 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
5174 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isNaN()) {
5175 if (FCmpInst::isOrdered(I.getPredicate())) // True if ordered and...
5176 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005177 assert(FCmpInst::isUnordered(I.getPredicate()) &&
5178 "Comparison must be either ordered or unordered!");
5179 // True if unordered.
5180 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005181 }
5182 }
5183
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005184 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5185 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
5186 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005187 // Only fold fcmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5188 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5189 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5190 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
5191 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5192 return NV;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005193 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005194 case Instruction::SIToFP:
5195 case Instruction::UIToFP:
5196 if (Instruction *NV = FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(I, LHSI, RHSC))
5197 return NV;
5198 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005199 case Instruction::Select:
5200 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5201 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5202 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5203 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5204 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5205 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5206 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
5207 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5208 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
5209 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5210 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5211 I.getName()), I);
5212 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5213 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
5214 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5215 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
5216 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5217 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5218 I.getName()), I);
5219 }
5220 }
5221
5222 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005223 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005224 break;
5225 }
5226 }
5227
5228 return Changed ? &I : 0;
5229}
5230
5231Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I) {
5232 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
5233 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
5234 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
5235
5236 // icmp X, X
5237 if (Op0 == Op1)
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00005238 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005239 I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005240
5241 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X icmp undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005242 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Christopher Lamb7a0678c2007-12-18 21:32:20 +00005243
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005244 // icmp <global/alloca*/null>, <global/alloca*/null> - Global/Stack value
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005245 // addresses never equal each other! We already know that Op0 != Op1.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005246 if ((isa<GlobalValue>(Op0) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op0) ||
5247 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0)) &&
5248 (isa<GlobalValue>(Op1) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op1) ||
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005249 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1)))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00005250 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005251 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005252
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005253 // icmp's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005254 if (Ty == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005255 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5256 default: assert(0 && "Invalid icmp instruction!");
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005257 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // icmp eq i1 A, B -> ~(A^B)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005258 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005259 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005260 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Xor);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005261 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005262 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // icmp eq i1 A, B -> A^B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005263 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005264
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005265 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005266 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp ugt -> icmp ult
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005267 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005268 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:{ // icmp ult i1 A, B -> ~A & B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005269 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005270 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005271 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005272 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005273 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5274 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sgt -> icmp slt
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005275 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005276 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: { // icmp slt i1 A, B -> A & ~B
5277 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
5278 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
5279 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op0);
5280 }
5281 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5282 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp uge -> icmp ule
5283 // FALL THROUGH
5284 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: { // icmp ule i1 A, B -> ~A | B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005285 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005286 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005287 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005288 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005289 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5290 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sge -> icmp sle
5291 // FALL THROUGH
5292 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { // icmp sle i1 A, B -> A | ~B
5293 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
5294 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
5295 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op0);
5296 }
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005297 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005298 }
5299
Chris Lattner2be51ae2004-06-09 04:24:29 +00005300 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
5301 // can be folded into the comparison.
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005302 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00005303 Value *A, *B;
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00005304
Chris Lattnerb6566012008-01-05 01:18:20 +00005305 // (icmp ne/eq (sub A B) 0) -> (icmp ne/eq A, B)
5306 if (I.isEquality() && CI->isNullValue() &&
5307 match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5308 // (icmp cond A B) if cond is equality
5309 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
Owen Andersonf5783f82007-12-28 07:42:12 +00005310 }
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00005311
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005312 // If we have a icmp le or icmp ge instruction, turn it into the appropriate
5313 // icmp lt or icmp gt instruction. This allows us to rely on them being
5314 // folded in the code below.
5315 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5316 default: break;
5317 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5318 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <=u MAX -> TRUE
5319 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5320 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5321 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5322 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <=s MAX -> TRUE
5323 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5324 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5325 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5326 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >=u MIN -> TRUE
5327 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5328 return new ICmpInst( ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5329 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5330 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >=s MIN -> TRUE
5331 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5332 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5333 }
5334
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005335 // See if we can fold the comparison based on range information we can get
5336 // by checking whether bits are known to be zero or one in the input.
5337 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
5338 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
5339
5340 // If this comparison is a normal comparison, it demands all
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005341 // bits, if it is a sign bit comparison, it only demands the sign bit.
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005342 bool UnusedBit;
5343 bool isSignBit = isSignBitCheck(I.getPredicate(), CI, UnusedBit);
5344
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005345 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(Op0,
5346 isSignBit ? APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth)
5347 : APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00005348 KnownZero, KnownOne, 0))
5349 return &I;
5350
5351 // Given the known and unknown bits, compute a range that the LHS could be
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005352 // in. Compute the Min, Max and RHS values based on the known bits. For the
5353 // EQ and NE we use unsigned values.
5354 APInt Min(BitWidth, 0), Max(BitWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005355 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(I.getPredicate()))
5356 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min, Max);
5357 else
5358 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne,Min,Max);
5359
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005360 // If Min and Max are known to be the same, then SimplifyDemandedBits
5361 // figured out that the LHS is a constant. Just constant fold this now so
5362 // that code below can assume that Min != Max.
5363 if (Min == Max)
5364 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(),
5365 ConstantInt::get(Min),
5366 CI));
5367
5368 // Based on the range information we know about the LHS, see if we can
5369 // simplify this comparison. For example, (x&4) < 8 is always true.
5370 const APInt &RHSVal = CI->getValue();
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005371 switch (I.getPredicate()) { // LE/GE have been folded already.
5372 default: assert(0 && "Unknown icmp opcode!");
5373 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
5374 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
5375 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5376 break;
5377 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
5378 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
5379 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5380 break;
5381 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005382 if (Max.ult(RHSVal)) // A <u C -> true iff max(A) < C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005383 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005384 if (Min.uge(RHSVal)) // A <u C -> false iff min(A) >= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005385 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005386 if (RHSVal == Max) // A <u MAX -> A != MAX
5387 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5388 if (RHSVal == Min+1) // A <u MIN+1 -> A == MIN
5389 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5390
5391 // (x <u 2147483648) -> (x >s -1) -> true if sign bit clear
5392 if (CI->isMinValue(true))
5393 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
5394 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005395 break;
5396 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005397 if (Min.ugt(RHSVal)) // A >u C -> true iff min(A) > C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005398 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005399 if (Max.ule(RHSVal)) // A >u C -> false iff max(A) <= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005400 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005401
5402 if (RHSVal == Min) // A >u MIN -> A != MIN
5403 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5404 if (RHSVal == Max-1) // A >u MAX-1 -> A == MAX
5405 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5406
5407 // (x >u 2147483647) -> (x <s 0) -> true if sign bit set
5408 if (CI->isMaxValue(true))
5409 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
5410 ConstantInt::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005411 break;
5412 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005413 if (Max.slt(RHSVal)) // A <s C -> true iff max(A) < C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005414 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerd01bee72008-07-11 06:40:29 +00005415 if (Min.sge(RHSVal)) // A <s C -> false iff min(A) >= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005416 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005417 if (RHSVal == Max) // A <s MAX -> A != MAX
5418 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera8ff4a82008-07-11 06:36:01 +00005419 if (RHSVal == Min+1) // A <s MIN+1 -> A == MIN
Chris Lattnerf9685ac2008-07-11 06:38:16 +00005420 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005421 break;
5422 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005423 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal)) // A >s C -> true iff min(A) > C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005424 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005425 if (Max.sle(RHSVal)) // A >s C -> false iff max(A) <= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005426 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005427
5428 if (RHSVal == Min) // A >s MIN -> A != MIN
5429 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5430 if (RHSVal == Max-1) // A >s MAX-1 -> A == MAX
5431 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005432 break;
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00005433 }
5434
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005435 // Since the RHS is a ConstantInt (CI), if the left hand side is an
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00005436 // instruction, see if that instruction also has constants so that the
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005437 // instruction can be folded into the icmp
Chris Lattner3c6a0d42004-05-25 06:32:08 +00005438 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005439 if (Instruction *Res = visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(I, LHSI, CI))
5440 return Res;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005441 }
5442
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005443 // Handle icmp with constant (but not simple integer constant) RHS
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005444 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
5445 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5446 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005447 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
5448 if (RHSC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005449 // icmp pred GEP (P, int 0, int 0, int 0), null -> icmp pred P, null
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005450 bool isAllZeros = true;
5451 for (unsigned i = 1, e = LHSI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5452 if (!isa<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i)) ||
5453 !cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5454 isAllZeros = false;
5455 break;
5456 }
5457 if (isAllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005458 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005459 Constant::getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
5460 }
5461 break;
5462
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005463 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005464 // Only fold icmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5465 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5466 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5467 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
5468 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5469 return NV;
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005470 break;
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005471 case Instruction::Select: {
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005472 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5473 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5474 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5475 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5476 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5477 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5478 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005479 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5480 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5481 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5482 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5483 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005484 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5485 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005486 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5487 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5488 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5489 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5490 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005491 }
5492 }
Jeff Cohen9d809302005-04-23 21:38:35 +00005493
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005494 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005495 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005496 break;
5497 }
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005498 case Instruction::Malloc:
5499 // If we have (malloc != null), and if the malloc has a single use, we
5500 // can assume it is successful and remove the malloc.
5501 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantPointerNull>(RHSC)) {
5502 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
5503 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005504 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005505 }
5506 break;
5507 }
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005508 }
5509
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005510 // If we can optimize a 'icmp GEP, P' or 'icmp P, GEP', do so now.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005511 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005512 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op1, I.getPredicate(), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005513 return NI;
5514 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005515 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op0,
5516 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(I.getPredicate()), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005517 return NI;
5518
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005519 // Test to see if the operands of the icmp are casted versions of other
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005520 // values. If the ptr->ptr cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so
5521 // now.
5522 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op0)) {
5523 if (isa<PointerType>(Op0->getType()) &&
5524 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<BitCastInst>(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005525 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
5526 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005527 Op0 = CI->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005528
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005529 // If operand #1 is a bitcast instruction, it must also be a ptr->ptr cast
5530 // so eliminate it as well.
5531 if (BitCastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op1))
5532 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005533
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005534 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005535 if (Op0->getType() != Op1->getType()) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005536 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00005537 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005538 } else {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005539 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the icmp
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00005540 Op1 = InsertBitCastBefore(Op1, Op0->getType(), I);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005541 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005542 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005543 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005544 }
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005545 }
5546
5547 if (isa<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005548 // Handle the special case of: icmp (cast bool to X), <cst>
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005549 // This comes up when you have code like
5550 // int X = A < B;
5551 // if (X) ...
5552 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005553 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
5554 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005555 if (Instruction *R = visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(I))
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005556 return R;
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005557 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005558
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005559 // See if it's the same type of instruction on the left and right.
5560 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
5561 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005562 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
5563 Op1I->hasOneUse() && Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
5564 I.isEquality()) {
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00005565 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005566 default: break;
5567 case Instruction::Add:
5568 case Instruction::Sub:
5569 case Instruction::Xor:
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005570 // a+x icmp eq/ne b+x --> a icmp b
5571 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0I->getOperand(0),
5572 Op1I->getOperand(0));
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005573 break;
5574 case Instruction::Mul:
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005575 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
5576 // a * Cst icmp eq/ne b * Cst --> a & Mask icmp b & Mask
5577 // Mask = -1 >> count-trailing-zeros(Cst).
5578 if (!CI->isZero() && !CI->isOne()) {
5579 const APInt &AP = CI->getValue();
5580 ConstantInt *Mask = ConstantInt::get(
5581 APInt::getLowBitsSet(AP.getBitWidth(),
5582 AP.getBitWidth() -
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005583 AP.countTrailingZeros()));
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00005584 Instruction *And1 = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0I->getOperand(0),
5585 Mask);
5586 Instruction *And2 = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op1I->getOperand(0),
5587 Mask);
5588 InsertNewInstBefore(And1, I);
5589 InsertNewInstBefore(And2, I);
5590 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), And1, And2);
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00005591 }
5592 }
5593 break;
5594 }
5595 }
5596 }
5597 }
5598
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00005599 // ~x < ~y --> y < x
5600 { Value *A, *B;
5601 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A))) &&
5602 match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B))))
5603 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, A);
5604 }
5605
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005606 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005607 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00005608
5609 // -x == -y --> x == y
5610 if (match(Op0, m_Neg(m_Value(A))) &&
5611 match(Op1, m_Neg(m_Value(B))))
5612 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
5613
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005614 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5615 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) { // (A^B) == A -> B == 0
5616 Value *OtherVal = A == Op1 ? B : A;
5617 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5618 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
5619 }
5620
5621 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5622 // A^c1 == C^c2 --> A == C^(c1^c2)
5623 if (ConstantInt *C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(B))
5624 if (ConstantInt *C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D))
5625 if (Op1->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00005626 Constant *NC = ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() ^ C2->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005627 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, NC, "tmp");
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005628 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A,
5629 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I));
5630 }
5631
5632 // A^B == A^D -> B == D
5633 if (A == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, D);
5634 if (A == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, C);
5635 if (B == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, D);
5636 if (B == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, C);
5637 }
5638 }
5639
5640 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5641 (A == Op0 || B == Op0)) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005642 // A == (A^B) -> B == 0
5643 Value *OtherVal = A == Op0 ? B : A;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005644 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5645 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005646 }
5647 if (match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op1) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005648 // (A-B) == A -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005649 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5650 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005651 }
5652 if (match(Op1, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op0) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005653 // A == (A-B) -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005654 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5655 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005656 }
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005657
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005658 // (X&Z) == (Y&Z) -> (X^Y) & Z == 0
5659 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse() &&
5660 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5661 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5662 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
5663
5664 if (A == C) {
5665 X = B; Y = D; Z = A;
5666 } else if (A == D) {
5667 X = B; Y = C; Z = A;
5668 } else if (B == C) {
5669 X = A; Y = D; Z = B;
5670 } else if (B == D) {
5671 X = A; Y = C; Z = B;
5672 }
5673
5674 if (X) { // Build (X^Y) & Z
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005675 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(X, Y, "tmp"), I);
5676 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op1, Z, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005677 I.setOperand(0, Op1);
5678 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()));
5679 return &I;
5680 }
5681 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005682 }
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005683 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005684}
5685
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005686
5687/// FoldICmpDivCst - Fold "icmp pred, ([su]div X, DivRHS), CmpRHS" where DivRHS
5688/// and CmpRHS are both known to be integer constants.
5689Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
5690 ConstantInt *DivRHS) {
5691 ConstantInt *CmpRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
5692 const APInt &CmpRHSV = CmpRHS->getValue();
5693
5694 // FIXME: If the operand types don't match the type of the divide
5695 // then don't attempt this transform. The code below doesn't have the
5696 // logic to deal with a signed divide and an unsigned compare (and
5697 // vice versa). This is because (x /s C1) <s C2 produces different
5698 // results than (x /s C1) <u C2 or (x /u C1) <s C2 or even
5699 // (x /u C1) <u C2. Simply casting the operands and result won't
5700 // work. :( The if statement below tests that condition and bails
5701 // if it finds it.
5702 bool DivIsSigned = DivI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv;
5703 if (!ICI.isEquality() && DivIsSigned != ICI.isSignedPredicate())
5704 return 0;
5705 if (DivRHS->isZero())
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005706 return 0; // The ProdOV computation fails on divide by zero.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005707
5708 // Compute Prod = CI * DivRHS. We are essentially solving an equation
5709 // of form X/C1=C2. We solve for X by multiplying C1 (DivRHS) and
5710 // C2 (CI). By solving for X we can turn this into a range check
5711 // instead of computing a divide.
5712 ConstantInt *Prod = Multiply(CmpRHS, DivRHS);
5713
5714 // Determine if the product overflows by seeing if the product is
5715 // not equal to the divide. Make sure we do the same kind of divide
5716 // as in the LHS instruction that we're folding.
5717 bool ProdOV = (DivIsSigned ? ConstantExpr::getSDiv(Prod, DivRHS) :
5718 ConstantExpr::getUDiv(Prod, DivRHS)) != CmpRHS;
5719
5720 // Get the ICmp opcode
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005721 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.getPredicate();
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005722
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005723 // Figure out the interval that is being checked. For example, a comparison
5724 // like "X /u 5 == 0" is really checking that X is in the interval [0, 5).
5725 // Compute this interval based on the constants involved and the signedness of
5726 // the compare/divide. This computes a half-open interval, keeping track of
5727 // whether either value in the interval overflows. After analysis each
5728 // overflow variable is set to 0 if it's corresponding bound variable is valid
5729 // -1 if overflowed off the bottom end, or +1 if overflowed off the top end.
5730 int LoOverflow = 0, HiOverflow = 0;
5731 ConstantInt *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
5732
5733
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005734 if (!DivIsSigned) { // udiv
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005735 // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005736 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005737 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
5738 if (!HiOverflow)
5739 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS, false);
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00005740 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) { // Divisor is > 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005741 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / pos) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005742 // Can't overflow. e.g. X/2 op 0 --> [-1, 2)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005743 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS)));
5744 HiBound = DivRHS;
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00005745 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / pos) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005746 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
5747 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
5748 if (!HiOverflow)
5749 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005750 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005751 // e.g. X/5 op -3 --> [-15-4, -15+1) --> [-19, -14)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005752 Constant *DivRHSH = ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS));
5753 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod,
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005754 cast<ConstantInt>(DivRHSH), true) ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005755 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005756 HiOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005757 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00005758 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isNegative()) { // Divisor is < 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005759 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / neg) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005760 // e.g. X/-5 op 0 --> [-4, 5)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005761 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS);
5762 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005763 if (HiBound == DivRHS) { // -INTMIN = INTMIN
5764 HiOverflow = 1; // [INTMIN+1, overflow)
5765 HiBound = 0; // e.g. X/INTMIN = 0 --> X > INTMIN
5766 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00005767 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / neg) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005768 // e.g. X/-5 op 3 --> [-19, -14)
5769 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005770 if (!LoOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005771 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod, AddOne(DivRHS), true) ?-1:0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005772 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
5773 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005774 // e.g. X/-5 op -3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005775 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005776 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV ? 1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005777 HiBound = Subtract(Prod, DivRHS);
5778 }
5779
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005780 // Dividing by a negative swaps the condition. LT <-> GT
5781 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005782 }
5783
5784 Value *X = DivI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005785 switch (Pred) {
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005786 default: assert(0 && "Unhandled icmp opcode!");
5787 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
5788 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
5789 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5790 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005791 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005792 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, LoBound);
5793 else if (LoOverflow)
5794 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
5795 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, HiBound);
5796 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005797 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, true, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005798 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
5799 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
5800 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5801 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005802 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005803 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, LoBound);
5804 else if (LoOverflow)
5805 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
5806 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
5807 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005808 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, false, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005809 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
5810 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005811 if (LoOverflow == +1) // Low bound is greater than input range.
5812 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5813 if (LoOverflow == -1) // Low bound is less than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005814 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005815 return new ICmpInst(Pred, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005816 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5817 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005818 if (HiOverflow == +1) // High bound greater than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005819 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005820 else if (HiOverflow == -1) // High bound less than input range.
5821 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5822 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005823 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
5824 else
5825 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, X, HiBound);
5826 }
5827}
5828
5829
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005830/// visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst - Handle "icmp (instr, intcst)".
5831///
5832Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
5833 Instruction *LHSI,
5834 ConstantInt *RHS) {
5835 const APInt &RHSV = RHS->getValue();
5836
5837 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Duncan Sands0091bf22007-04-04 06:42:45 +00005838 case Instruction::Xor: // (icmp pred (xor X, XorCST), CI)
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005839 if (ConstantInt *XorCST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5840 // If this is a comparison that tests the signbit (X < 0) or (x > -1),
5841 // fold the xor.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005842 if ((ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && RHSV == 0) ||
5843 (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && RHSV.isAllOnesValue())) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005844 Value *CompareVal = LHSI->getOperand(0);
5845
5846 // If the sign bit of the XorCST is not set, there is no change to
5847 // the operation, just stop using the Xor.
5848 if (!XorCST->getValue().isNegative()) {
5849 ICI.setOperand(0, CompareVal);
5850 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
5851 return &ICI;
5852 }
5853
5854 // Was the old condition true if the operand is positive?
5855 bool isTrueIfPositive = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5856
5857 // If so, the new one isn't.
5858 isTrueIfPositive ^= true;
5859
5860 if (isTrueIfPositive)
5861 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CompareVal, SubOne(RHS));
5862 else
5863 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CompareVal, AddOne(RHS));
5864 }
5865 }
5866 break;
5867 case Instruction::And: // (icmp pred (and X, AndCST), RHS)
5868 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
5869 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
5870 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
5871
5872 // If the LHS is an AND of a truncating cast, we can widen the
5873 // and/compare to be the input width without changing the value
5874 // produced, eliminating a cast.
5875 if (TruncInst *Cast = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
5876 // We can do this transformation if either the AND constant does not
5877 // have its sign bit set or if it is an equality comparison.
5878 // Extending a relational comparison when we're checking the sign
5879 // bit would not work.
5880 if (Cast->hasOneUse() &&
Anton Korobeynikov4aefd6b2008-02-20 12:07:57 +00005881 (ICI.isEquality() ||
5882 (AndCST->getValue().isNonNegative() && RHSV.isNonNegative()))) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005883 uint32_t BitWidth =
5884 cast<IntegerType>(Cast->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
5885 APInt NewCST = AndCST->getValue();
5886 NewCST.zext(BitWidth);
5887 APInt NewCI = RHSV;
5888 NewCI.zext(BitWidth);
5889 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005890 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Cast->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005891 ConstantInt::get(NewCST),LHSI->getName());
5892 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
5893 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewAnd,
5894 ConstantInt::get(NewCI));
5895 }
5896 }
5897
5898 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
5899 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
5900 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
5901 // access.
5902 BinaryOperator *Shift = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
5903 if (Shift && !Shift->isShift())
5904 Shift = 0;
5905
5906 ConstantInt *ShAmt;
5907 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
5908 const Type *Ty = Shift ? Shift->getType() : 0; // Type of the shift.
5909 const Type *AndTy = AndCST->getType(); // Type of the and.
5910
5911 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
5912 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
5913 // rights, as they sign-extend.
5914 if (ShAmt) {
5915 bool CanFold = Shift->isLogicalShift();
5916 if (!CanFold) {
5917 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
5918 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
5919 uint32_t TyBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5920 int ShAmtVal = TyBits - ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TyBits);
5921
5922 uint32_t BitWidth = AndTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5923 if ((APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-ShAmtVal) &
5924 AndCST->getValue()) == 0)
5925 CanFold = true;
5926 }
5927
5928 if (CanFold) {
5929 Constant *NewCst;
5930 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
5931 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt);
5932 else
5933 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt);
5934
5935 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
5936 // compared.
5937 if (ConstantExpr::get(Shift->getOpcode(), NewCst, ShAmt) != RHS) {
5938 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
5939 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
5940 // result is always true or false now.
5941 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
5942 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5943 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
5944 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5945 } else {
5946 ICI.setOperand(1, NewCst);
5947 Constant *NewAndCST;
5948 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
5949 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
5950 else
5951 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
5952 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
5953 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
5954 AddToWorkList(Shift); // Shift is dead.
5955 AddUsesToWorkList(ICI);
5956 return &ICI;
5957 }
5958 }
5959 }
5960
5961 // Turn ((X >> Y) & C) == 0 into (X & (C << Y)) == 0. The later is
5962 // preferable because it allows the C<<Y expression to be hoisted out
5963 // of a loop if Y is invariant and X is not.
5964 if (Shift && Shift->hasOneUse() && RHSV == 0 &&
5965 ICI.isEquality() && !Shift->isArithmeticShift() &&
5966 isa<Instruction>(Shift->getOperand(0))) {
5967 // Compute C << Y.
5968 Value *NS;
5969 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005970 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(AndCST,
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005971 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
5972 } else {
5973 // Insert a logical shift.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005974 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(AndCST,
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005975 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
5976 }
5977 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NS), ICI);
5978
5979 // Compute X & (C << Y).
5980 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005981 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift->getOperand(0), NS, LHSI->getName());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005982 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
5983
5984 ICI.setOperand(0, NewAnd);
5985 return &ICI;
5986 }
5987 }
5988 break;
5989
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005990 case Instruction::Shl: { // (icmp pred (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
5991 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
5992 if (!ShAmt) break;
5993
5994 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
5995
5996 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
5997 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
5998 // simplified.
5999 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
6000 break;
6001
6002 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
6003 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
6004 // comparison cannot succeed.
6005 Constant *Comp =
6006 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt), ShAmt);
6007 if (Comp != RHS) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6008 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6009 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
6010 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6011 }
6012
6013 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6014 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6015 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
6016 Constant *Mask =
6017 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-ShAmtVal));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006018
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006019 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006020 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006021 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6022 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6023 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
6024 ConstantInt::get(RHSV.lshr(ShAmtVal)));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006025 }
6026 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006027
6028 // Otherwise, if this is a comparison of the sign bit, simplify to and/test.
6029 bool TrueIfSigned = false;
6030 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6031 isSignBitCheck(ICI.getPredicate(), RHS, TrueIfSigned)) {
6032 // (X << 31) <s 0 --> (X&1) != 0
6033 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(APInt(TypeBits, 1) <<
6034 (TypeBits-ShAmt->getZExtValue()-1));
6035 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006036 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006037 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6038 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6039
6040 return new ICmpInst(TrueIfSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_NE : ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ,
6041 And, Constant::getNullValue(And->getType()));
6042 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006043 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006044 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006045
6046 case Instruction::LShr: // (icmp pred (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006047 case Instruction::AShr: {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006048 // Only handle equality comparisons of shift-by-constant.
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006049 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006050 if (!ShAmt || !ICI.isEquality()) break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006051
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006052 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
6053 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
6054 // simplified.
6055 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
6056 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
6057 break;
6058
6059 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006060
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006061 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
6062 // comparison cannot succeed.
6063 APInt Comp = RHSV << ShAmtVal;
6064 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)
6065 Comp = Comp.lshr(ShAmtVal);
6066 else
6067 Comp = Comp.ashr(ShAmtVal);
6068
6069 if (Comp != RHSV) { // Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6070 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6071 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
6072 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6073 }
6074
6075 // Otherwise, check to see if the bits shifted out are known to be zero.
6076 // If so, we can compare against the unshifted value:
6077 // (X & 4) >> 1 == 2 --> (X & 4) == 4.
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006078 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6079 MaskedValueIsZero(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006080 APInt::getLowBitsSet(Comp.getBitWidth(), ShAmtVal))) {
6081 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
6082 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
6083 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006084
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006085 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006086 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6087 APInt Val(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShAmtVal));
6088 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(Val);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006089
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006090 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006091 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006092 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6093 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6094 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
6095 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006096 }
6097 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006098 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006099
6100 case Instruction::SDiv:
6101 case Instruction::UDiv:
6102 // Fold: icmp pred ([us]div X, C1), C2 -> range test
6103 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
6104 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
6105 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
6106 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
6107 // See: InsertRangeTest above for the kinds of replacements possible.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006108 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)))
6109 if (Instruction *R = FoldICmpDivCst(ICI, cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI),
6110 DivRHS))
6111 return R;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006112 break;
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00006113
6114 case Instruction::Add:
6115 // Fold: icmp pred (add, X, C1), C2
6116
6117 if (!ICI.isEquality()) {
6118 ConstantInt *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6119 if (!LHSC) break;
6120 const APInt &LHSV = LHSC->getValue();
6121
6122 ConstantRange CR = ICI.makeConstantRange(ICI.getPredicate(), RHSV)
6123 .subtract(LHSV);
6124
6125 if (ICI.isSignedPredicate()) {
6126 if (CR.getLower().isSignBit()) {
6127 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6128 ConstantInt::get(CR.getUpper()));
6129 } else if (CR.getUpper().isSignBit()) {
6130 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6131 ConstantInt::get(CR.getLower()));
6132 }
6133 } else {
6134 if (CR.getLower().isMinValue()) {
6135 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6136 ConstantInt::get(CR.getUpper()));
6137 } else if (CR.getUpper().isMinValue()) {
6138 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6139 ConstantInt::get(CR.getLower()));
6140 }
6141 }
6142 }
6143 break;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006144 }
6145
6146 // Simplify icmp_eq and icmp_ne instructions with integer constant RHS.
6147 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
6148 bool isICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6149
6150 // If the first operand is (add|sub|and|or|xor|rem) with a constant, and
6151 // the second operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
6152 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)) {
6153 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
6154 case Instruction::SRem:
6155 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
6156 if (RHSV == 0 && isa<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&BO->hasOneUse()){
6157 const APInt &V = cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue();
6158 if (V.sgt(APInt(V.getBitWidth(), 1)) && V.isPowerOf2()) {
6159 Instruction *NewRem =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006160 BinaryOperator::CreateURem(BO->getOperand(0), BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006161 BO->getName());
6162 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRem, ICI);
6163 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewRem,
6164 Constant::getNullValue(BO->getType()));
6165 }
6166 }
6167 break;
6168 case Instruction::Add:
6169 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
6170 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6171 if (BO->hasOneUse())
6172 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6173 Subtract(RHS, BOp1C));
6174 } else if (RHSV == 0) {
6175 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
6176 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
6177 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
6178
6179 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1))
6180 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, NegVal);
6181 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0))
6182 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NegVal, BOp1);
6183 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006184 Instruction *Neg = BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(BOp1);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006185 InsertNewInstBefore(Neg, ICI);
6186 Neg->takeName(BO);
6187 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, Neg);
6188 }
6189 }
6190 break;
6191 case Instruction::Xor:
6192 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
6193 // the explicit xor.
6194 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
6195 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6196 ConstantExpr::getXor(RHS, BOC));
6197
6198 // FALLTHROUGH
6199 case Instruction::Sub:
6200 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
6201 if (RHSV == 0)
6202 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6203 BO->getOperand(1));
6204 break;
6205
6206 case Instruction::Or:
6207 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
6208 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
6209 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6210 Constant *NotCI = ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS);
6211 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
6212 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
6213 isICMP_NE));
6214 }
6215 break;
6216
6217 case Instruction::And:
6218 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6219 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
6220 // comparison can never succeed!
6221 if ((RHSV & ~BOC->getValue()) != 0)
6222 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
6223 isICMP_NE));
6224
6225 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
6226 if (RHS == BOC && RHSV.isPowerOf2())
6227 return new ICmpInst(isICMP_NE ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ :
6228 ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHSI,
6229 Constant::getNullValue(RHS->getType()));
6230
6231 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x s< 0
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00006232 if (BOC->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006233 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
6234 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(X->getType());
6235 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
6236 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
6237 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, Zero);
6238 }
6239
6240 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
6241 if (RHSV == 0 && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
6242 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
6243 Constant *NegX = ConstantExpr::getNeg(BOC);
6244 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
6245 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
6246 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, NegX);
6247 }
6248 }
6249 default: break;
6250 }
6251 } else if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(LHSI)) {
6252 // Handle icmp {eq|ne} <intrinsic>, intcst.
6253 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap) {
6254 AddToWorkList(II);
6255 ICI.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
6256 ICI.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(RHSV.byteSwap()));
6257 return &ICI;
6258 }
6259 }
6260 } else { // Not a ICMP_EQ/ICMP_NE
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00006261 // If the LHS is a cast from an integral value of the same size,
6262 // then since we know the RHS is a constant, try to simlify.
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006263 if (CastInst *Cast = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHSI)) {
6264 Value *CastOp = Cast->getOperand(0);
6265 const Type *SrcTy = CastOp->getType();
6266 uint32_t SrcTySize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6267 if (SrcTy->isInteger() &&
6268 SrcTySize == Cast->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
6269 // If this is an unsigned comparison, try to make the comparison use
6270 // smaller constant values.
6271 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT && RHSV.isSignBit()) {
6272 // X u< 128 => X s> -1
6273 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CastOp,
6274 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTySize)));
6275 } else if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT &&
6276 RHSV == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(SrcTySize)) {
6277 // X u> 127 => X s< 0
6278 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CastOp,
6279 Constant::getNullValue(SrcTy));
6280 }
6281 }
6282 }
6283 }
6284 return 0;
6285}
6286
6287/// visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast - Handle icmp (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
6288/// We only handle extending casts so far.
6289///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006290Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI) {
6291 const CastInst *LHSCI = cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006292 Value *LHSCIOp = LHSCI->getOperand(0);
6293 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006294 const Type *DestTy = LHSCI->getType();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006295 Value *RHSCIOp;
6296
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006297 // Turn icmp (ptrtoint x), (ptrtoint/c) into a compare of the input if the
6298 // integer type is the same size as the pointer type.
6299 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt &&
6300 getTargetData().getPointerSizeInBits() ==
6301 cast<IntegerType>(DestTy)->getBitWidth()) {
6302 Value *RHSOp = 0;
6303 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6f6f5122007-05-06 07:24:03 +00006304 RHSOp = ConstantExpr::getIntToPtr(RHSC, SrcTy);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006305 } else if (PtrToIntInst *RHSC = dyn_cast<PtrToIntInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
6306 RHSOp = RHSC->getOperand(0);
6307 // If the pointer types don't match, insert a bitcast.
6308 if (LHSCIOp->getType() != RHSOp->getType())
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00006309 RHSOp = InsertBitCastBefore(RHSOp, LHSCIOp->getType(), ICI);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006310 }
6311
6312 if (RHSOp)
6313 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSOp);
6314 }
6315
6316 // The code below only handles extension cast instructions, so far.
6317 // Enforce this.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006318 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::ZExt &&
6319 LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::SExt)
Chris Lattnerb352fa52005-01-17 03:20:02 +00006320 return 0;
6321
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006322 bool isSignedExt = LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt;
6323 bool isSignedCmp = ICI.isSignedPredicate();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006324
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006325 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006326 // Not an extension from the same type?
6327 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006328 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType())
6329 return 0;
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00006330
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00006331 // If the signedness of the two casts doesn't agree (i.e. one is a sext
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00006332 // and the other is a zext), then we can't handle this.
6333 if (CI->getOpcode() != LHSCI->getOpcode())
6334 return 0;
6335
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00006336 // Deal with equality cases early.
6337 if (ICI.isEquality())
6338 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
6339
6340 // A signed comparison of sign extended values simplifies into a
6341 // signed comparison.
6342 if (isSignedCmp && isSignedExt)
6343 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
6344
6345 // The other three cases all fold into an unsigned comparison.
6346 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getUnsignedPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Reid Spencer6731d5c2004-11-28 21:31:15 +00006347 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006348
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006349 // If we aren't dealing with a constant on the RHS, exit early
6350 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
6351 if (!CI)
6352 return 0;
6353
6354 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
6355 // reextended to DestTy.
6356 Constant *Res1 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(CI, SrcTy);
6357 Constant *Res2 = ConstantExpr::getCast(LHSCI->getOpcode(), Res1, DestTy);
6358
6359 // If the re-extended constant didn't change...
6360 if (Res2 == CI) {
6361 // Make sure that sign of the Cmp and the sign of the Cast are the same.
6362 // For example, we might have:
6363 // %A = sext short %X to uint
6364 // %B = icmp ugt uint %A, 1330
6365 // It is incorrect to transform this into
6366 // %B = icmp ugt short %X, 1330
6367 // because %A may have negative value.
6368 //
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006369 // However, we allow this when the compare is EQ/NE, because they are
6370 // signless.
6371 if (isSignedExt == isSignedCmp || ICI.isEquality())
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006372 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006373 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006374 }
6375
6376 // The re-extended constant changed so the constant cannot be represented
6377 // in the shorter type. Consequently, we cannot emit a simple comparison.
6378
6379 // First, handle some easy cases. We know the result cannot be equal at this
6380 // point so handle the ICI.isEquality() cases
6381 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006382 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006383 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006384 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006385
6386 // Evaluate the comparison for LT (we invert for GT below). LE and GE cases
6387 // should have been folded away previously and not enter in here.
6388 Value *Result;
6389 if (isSignedCmp) {
6390 // We're performing a signed comparison.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00006391 if (cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue().isNegative())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006392 Result = ConstantInt::getFalse(); // X < (small) --> false
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006393 else
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006394 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(); // X < (large) --> true
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006395 } else {
6396 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
6397 if (isSignedExt) {
6398 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
6399 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006400 Constant *NegOne = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006401 Result = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHSCIOp,
6402 NegOne, ICI.getName()), ICI);
6403 } else {
6404 // Unsigned extend & unsigned compare -> always true.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006405 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006406 }
6407 }
6408
6409 // Finally, return the value computed.
6410 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006411 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006412 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Result);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006413
6414 assert((ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT ||
6415 ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) &&
6416 "ICmp should be folded!");
6417 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
6418 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantExpr::getNot(CI));
6419 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Result);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006420}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006421
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006422Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
6423 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
6424}
6425
6426Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
6427 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
6428}
6429
6430Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006431 if (Instruction *R = commonShiftTransforms(I))
6432 return R;
6433
6434 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
6435
6436 // ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
6437 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
6438 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
6439 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
6440
6441 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
Nate Begeman5bc1ea02008-07-29 15:49:41 +00006442 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType()) &&
6443 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006444 APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006445 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006446
6447 return 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006448}
6449
6450Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
6451 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00006452 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006453
6454 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
6455 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006456 if (Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00006457 Op0 == Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
6458 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006459
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006460 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
6461 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
Chris Lattner79a564c2004-10-16 23:28:04 +00006462 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006463 else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006464 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
6465 }
6466 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006467 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
6468 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
6469 else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006470 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006471 }
6472
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006473 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
6474 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
6475 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006476 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006477 return R;
6478
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006479 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006480 if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
6481 return Res;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006482 return 0;
6483}
6484
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006485Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006486 BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006487 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006488
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006489 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
6490 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006491 uint32_t TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6492 APInt KnownZero(TypeBits, 0), KnownOne(TypeBits, 0);
6493 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits),
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006494 KnownZero, KnownOne))
6495 return &I;
6496
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006497 // shl uint X, 32 = 0 and shr ubyte Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate shr
6498 // of a signed value.
6499 //
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00006500 if (Op1->uge(TypeBits)) {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00006501 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006502 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
6503 else {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00006504 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006505 return &I;
Chris Lattner8adac752004-02-23 20:30:06 +00006506 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006507 }
6508
6509 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
6510 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
6511 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
6512 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006513 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006514 ConstantExpr::getShl(BOOp, Op1));
6515
6516 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
6517 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
6518 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
6519 return R;
6520 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
6521 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
6522 return NV;
6523
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006524 // Fold shift2(trunc(shift1(x,c1)), c2) -> trunc(shift2(shift1(x,c1),c2))
6525 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(Op0)) {
6526 Instruction *TrOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TI->getOperand(0));
6527 // If 'shift2' is an ashr, we would have to get the sign bit into a funny
6528 // place. Don't try to do this transformation in this case. Also, we
6529 // require that the input operand is a shift-by-constant so that we have
6530 // confidence that the shifts will get folded together. We could do this
6531 // xform in more cases, but it is unlikely to be profitable.
6532 if (TrOp && I.isLogicalShift() && TrOp->isShift() &&
6533 isa<ConstantInt>(TrOp->getOperand(1))) {
6534 // Okay, we'll do this xform. Make the shift of shift.
6535 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Op1, TrOp->getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006536 Instruction *NSh = BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), TrOp, ShAmt,
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006537 I.getName());
6538 InsertNewInstBefore(NSh, I); // (shift2 (shift1 & 0x00FF), c2)
6539
6540 // For logical shifts, the truncation has the effect of making the high
6541 // part of the register be zeros. Emulate this by inserting an AND to
6542 // clear the top bits as needed. This 'and' will usually be zapped by
6543 // other xforms later if dead.
6544 unsigned SrcSize = TrOp->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6545 unsigned DstSize = TI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6546 APInt MaskV(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, DstSize));
6547
6548 // The mask we constructed says what the trunc would do if occurring
6549 // between the shifts. We want to know the effect *after* the second
6550 // shift. We know that it is a logical shift by a constant, so adjust the
6551 // mask as appropriate.
6552 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6553 MaskV <<= Op1->getZExtValue();
6554 else {
6555 assert(I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr && "Unknown logical shift");
6556 MaskV = MaskV.lshr(Op1->getZExtValue());
6557 }
6558
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006559 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NSh, ConstantInt::get(MaskV),
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00006560 TI->getName());
6561 InsertNewInstBefore(And, I); // shift1 & 0x00FF
6562
6563 // Return the value truncated to the interesting size.
6564 return new TruncInst(And, I.getType());
6565 }
6566 }
6567
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006568 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006569 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
6570 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
6571 Value *V1, *V2;
6572 ConstantInt *CC;
6573 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006574 default: break;
6575 case Instruction::Add:
6576 case Instruction::And:
6577 case Instruction::Or:
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006578 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006579 // These operators commute.
6580 // Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006581 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
6582 match(Op0BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006583 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006584 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006585 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006586 Op0BO->getName());
6587 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006588 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006589 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006590 Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006591 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006592 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006593 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00006594 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006595 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006596
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006597 // Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006598 Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00006599 if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() &&
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006600 match(Op0BOOp1,
6601 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),m_ConstantInt(CC))) &&
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00006602 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6603 V2 == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006604 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006605 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
6606 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006607 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
6608 Instruction *XM =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006609 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006610 V1->getName()+".mask");
6611 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
6612
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006613 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006614 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006615 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006616
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006617 // FALL THROUGH.
6618 case Instruction::Sub: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006619 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006620 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6621 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006622 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006623 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006624 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
6625 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006626 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006627 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006628 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006629 Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006630 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006631 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006632 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00006633 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006634 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006635
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00006636 // Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006637 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
6638 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
6639 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006640 m_ConstantInt(CC))) && V2 == Op1 &&
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00006641 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
6642 ->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006643 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006644 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
6645 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006646 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
6647 Instruction *XM =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006648 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006649 V1->getName()+".mask");
6650 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
6651
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006652 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00006653 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006654
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006655 break;
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00006656 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006657 }
6658
6659
6660 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
6661 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
6662 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
6663 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
6664 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
6665
6666 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00006667 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
Chris Lattner1f7e1602004-10-08 03:46:20 +00006668 case Instruction::Add:
6669 isValid = isLeftShift;
6670 break;
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00006671 case Instruction::Or:
6672 case Instruction::Xor:
6673 highBitSet = false;
6674 break;
6675 case Instruction::And:
6676 highBitSet = true;
6677 break;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006678 }
6679
6680 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
6681 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
6682 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
6683 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
6684 // operation.
6685 //
Chris Lattnerc95ba442007-12-06 06:25:04 +00006686 if (isValid && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006687 isValid = Op0C->getValue()[TypeBits-1] == highBitSet;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006688
6689 if (isValid) {
6690 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
6691
6692 Instruction *NewShift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006693 BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006694 InsertNewInstBefore(NewShift, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006695 NewShift->takeName(Op0BO);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006696
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006697 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006698 NewRHS);
6699 }
6700 }
6701 }
6702 }
6703
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006704 // Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006705 BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
6706 if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
6707 ShiftOp = 0;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006708
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006709 if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006710 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00006711 uint32_t ShiftAmt1 = ShiftAmt1C->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
6712 uint32_t ShiftAmt2 = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006713 assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
6714 if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
6715 Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006716
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006717 uint32_t AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006718 if (AmtSum > TypeBits)
6719 AmtSum = TypeBits;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006720
6721 const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
6722
6723 // Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
Chris Lattner7f3da2d2007-02-03 23:28:07 +00006724 if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006725 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), X,
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006726 ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
6727 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
6728 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
6729 // ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006730 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006731 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
6732 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6733 // ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
6734 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006735 BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006736 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6737
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006738 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006739 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006740 }
6741
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006742 // Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
6743 // right. See if the amounts are equal.
6744 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
6745 // If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
6746 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006747 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006748 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006749 }
6750 // If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
6751 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00006752 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006753 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006754 }
6755 // We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
6756 // NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
6757 // types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
6758 // generators.
6759 const Type *SExtType = 0;
6760 switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006761 case 1 :
6762 case 8 :
6763 case 16 :
6764 case 32 :
6765 case 64 :
6766 case 128:
6767 SExtType = IntegerType::get(Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1);
6768 break;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006769 default: break;
6770 }
6771 if (SExtType) {
6772 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(X, SExtType, "sext");
6773 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
6774 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, Ty);
6775 }
6776 // Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
6777 } else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006778 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006779
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006780 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006781 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6782 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
6783 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00006784 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006785 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00006786 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6787
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006788 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006789 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006790 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006791
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006792 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006793 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6794 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
6795 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006796 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006797 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006798
Reid Spencerd5e30f02007-03-26 17:18:58 +00006799 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006800 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006801 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006802
6803 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
6804 } else {
6805 assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006806 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006807
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006808 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006809 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6810 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
6811 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
6812 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006813 BinaryOperator::Create(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006814 ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
6815 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6816
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006817 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006818 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006819 }
6820
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006821 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006822 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6823 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
6824 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006825 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006826 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6827
Reid Spencer68d27cf2007-03-26 23:45:51 +00006828 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006829 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006830 }
6831
6832 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006833 }
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006834 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006835 return 0;
6836}
6837
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00006838
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006839/// DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr - Analyze 'Val', seeing if it is a simple linear
6840/// expression. If so, decompose it, returning some value X, such that Val is
6841/// X*Scale+Offset.
6842///
6843static Value *DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(Value *Val, unsigned &Scale,
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006844 int &Offset) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006845 assert(Val->getType() == Type::Int32Ty && "Unexpected allocation size type!");
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006846 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Val)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006847 Offset = CI->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00006848 Scale = 0;
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006849 return ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0);
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00006850 } else if (BinaryOperator *I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Val)) {
6851 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
6852 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6853 // This is a value scaled by '1 << the shift amt'.
6854 Scale = 1U << RHS->getZExtValue();
6855 Offset = 0;
6856 return I->getOperand(0);
6857 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
6858 // This value is scaled by 'RHS'.
6859 Scale = RHS->getZExtValue();
6860 Offset = 0;
6861 return I->getOperand(0);
6862 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
6863 // We have X+C. Check to see if we really have (X*C2)+C1,
6864 // where C1 is divisible by C2.
6865 unsigned SubScale;
6866 Value *SubVal =
6867 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(I->getOperand(0), SubScale, Offset);
6868 Offset += RHS->getZExtValue();
6869 Scale = SubScale;
6870 return SubVal;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006871 }
6872 }
6873 }
6874
6875 // Otherwise, we can't look past this.
6876 Scale = 1;
6877 Offset = 0;
6878 return Val;
6879}
6880
6881
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006882/// PromoteCastOfAllocation - If we find a cast of an allocation instruction,
6883/// try to eliminate the cast by moving the type information into the alloc.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006884Instruction *InstCombiner::PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI,
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006885 AllocationInst &AI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006886 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006887
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006888 // Remove any uses of AI that are dead.
6889 assert(!CI.use_empty() && "Dead instructions should be removed earlier!");
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00006890
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006891 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI.use_begin(), E = AI.use_end(); UI != E; ) {
6892 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI++);
6893 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(User)) {
6894 while (UI != E && *UI == User)
6895 ++UI; // If this instruction uses AI more than once, don't break UI.
6896
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006897 ++NumDeadInst;
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +00006898 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *User;
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00006899 EraseInstFromFunction(*User);
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006900 }
6901 }
6902
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006903 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to.
6904 const Type *AllocElTy = AI.getAllocatedType();
6905 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
6906 if (!AllocElTy->isSized() || !CastElTy->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006907
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00006908 unsigned AllocElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AllocElTy);
6909 unsigned CastElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006910 if (CastElTyAlign < AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
6911
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006912 // If the allocation has multiple uses, only promote it if we are strictly
6913 // increasing the alignment of the resultant allocation. If we keep it the
6914 // same, we open the door to infinite loops of various kinds.
6915 if (!AI.hasOneUse() && CastElTyAlign == AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
6916
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00006917 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getABITypeSize(AllocElTy);
6918 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getABITypeSize(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00006919 if (CastElTySize == 0 || AllocElTySize == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006920
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006921 // See if we can satisfy the modulus by pulling a scale out of the array
6922 // size argument.
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006923 unsigned ArraySizeScale;
6924 int ArrayOffset;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006925 Value *NumElements = // See if the array size is a decomposable linear expr.
6926 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(AI.getOperand(0), ArraySizeScale, ArrayOffset);
6927
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006928 // If we can now satisfy the modulus, by using a non-1 scale, we really can
6929 // do the xform.
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006930 if ((AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale) % CastElTySize != 0 ||
6931 (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset ) % CastElTySize != 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00006932
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006933 unsigned Scale = (AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale)/CastElTySize;
6934 Value *Amt = 0;
6935 if (Scale == 1) {
6936 Amt = NumElements;
6937 } else {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006938 // If the allocation size is constant, form a constant mul expression
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006939 Amt = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Scale);
6940 if (isa<ConstantInt>(NumElements))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00006941 Amt = Multiply(cast<ConstantInt>(NumElements), cast<ConstantInt>(Amt));
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006942 // otherwise multiply the amount and the number of elements
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006943 else if (Scale != 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006944 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Amt, NumElements, "tmp");
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006945 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00006946 }
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00006947 }
6948
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006949 if (int Offset = (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset)/CastElTySize) {
6950 Value *Off = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Offset, true);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006951 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Amt, Off, "tmp");
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006952 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
6953 }
6954
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006955 AllocationInst *New;
6956 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006957 New = new MallocInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006958 else
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006959 New = new AllocaInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006960 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006961 New->takeName(&AI);
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006962
6963 // If the allocation has multiple uses, insert a cast and change all things
6964 // that used it to use the new cast. This will also hack on CI, but it will
6965 // die soon.
6966 if (!AI.hasOneUse()) {
6967 AddUsesToWorkList(AI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006968 // New is the allocation instruction, pointer typed. AI is the original
6969 // allocation instruction, also pointer typed. Thus, cast to use is BitCast.
6970 CastInst *NewCast = new BitCastInst(New, AI.getType(), "tmpcast");
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006971 InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, AI);
6972 AI.replaceAllUsesWith(NewCast);
6973 }
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006974 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
6975}
6976
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006977/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType - Return true if we can take the specified value
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006978/// and return it as type Ty without inserting any new casts and without
6979/// changing the computed value. This is used by code that tries to decide
6980/// whether promoting or shrinking integer operations to wider or smaller types
6981/// will allow us to eliminate a truncate or extend.
6982///
6983/// This is a truncation operation if Ty is smaller than V->getType(), or an
6984/// extension operation if Ty is larger.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00006985///
6986/// If CastOpc is a truncation, then Ty will be a type smaller than V. We
6987/// should return true if trunc(V) can be computed by computing V in the smaller
6988/// type. If V is an instruction, then trunc(inst(x,y)) can be computed as
6989/// inst(trunc(x),trunc(y)), which only makes sense if x and y can be
6990/// efficiently truncated.
6991///
6992/// If CastOpc is a sext or zext, we are asking if the low bits of the value can
6993/// bit computed in a larger type, which is then and'd or sext_in_reg'd to get
6994/// the final result.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00006995bool InstCombiner::CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
6996 unsigned CastOpc,
6997 int &NumCastsRemoved) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006998 // We can always evaluate constants in another type.
6999 if (isa<ConstantInt>(V))
7000 return true;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007001
7002 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007003 if (!I) return false;
7004
7005 const IntegerType *OrigTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007006
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007007 // If this is an extension or truncate, we can often eliminate it.
7008 if (isa<TruncInst>(I) || isa<ZExtInst>(I) || isa<SExtInst>(I)) {
7009 // If this is a cast from the destination type, we can trivially eliminate
7010 // it, and this will remove a cast overall.
7011 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty) {
7012 // If the first operand is itself a cast, and is eliminable, do not count
7013 // this as an eliminable cast. We would prefer to eliminate those two
7014 // casts first.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007015 if (!isa<CastInst>(I->getOperand(0)) && I->hasOneUse())
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007016 ++NumCastsRemoved;
7017 return true;
7018 }
7019 }
7020
7021 // We can't extend or shrink something that has multiple uses: doing so would
7022 // require duplicating the instruction in general, which isn't profitable.
7023 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
7024
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007025 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007026 case Instruction::Add:
7027 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007028 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007029 case Instruction::And:
7030 case Instruction::Or:
7031 case Instruction::Xor:
7032 // These operators can all arbitrarily be extended or truncated.
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007033 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7034 NumCastsRemoved) &&
7035 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
7036 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007037
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007038 case Instruction::Shl:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007039 // If we are truncating the result of this SHL, and if it's a shift of a
7040 // constant amount, we can always perform a SHL in a smaller type.
7041 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007042 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
7043 if (BitWidth < OrigTy->getBitWidth() &&
7044 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth)
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007045 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7046 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007047 }
7048 break;
7049 case Instruction::LShr:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007050 // If this is a truncate of a logical shr, we can truncate it to a smaller
7051 // lshr iff we know that the bits we would otherwise be shifting in are
7052 // already zeros.
7053 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007054 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getBitWidth();
7055 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
7056 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth &&
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007057 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007058 APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth)) &&
7059 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth) {
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007060 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7061 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007062 }
7063 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007064 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007065 case Instruction::ZExt:
7066 case Instruction::SExt:
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007067 case Instruction::Trunc:
7068 // If this is the same kind of case as our original (e.g. zext+zext), we
Chris Lattner5543a852007-08-02 17:23:38 +00007069 // can safely replace it. Note that replacing it does not reduce the number
7070 // of casts in the input.
7071 if (I->getOpcode() == CastOpc)
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007072 return true;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007073 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007074 case Instruction::Select: {
7075 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I);
7076 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getTrueValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
7077 NumCastsRemoved) &&
7078 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getFalseValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
7079 NumCastsRemoved);
7080 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007081 case Instruction::PHI: {
7082 // We can change a phi if we can change all operands.
7083 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I);
7084 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
7085 if (!CanEvaluateInDifferentType(PN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, CastOpc,
7086 NumCastsRemoved))
7087 return false;
7088 return true;
7089 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007090 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007091 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
7092 break;
7093 }
7094
7095 return false;
7096}
7097
7098/// EvaluateInDifferentType - Given an expression that
7099/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType returns true for, actually insert the code to
7100/// evaluate the expression.
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007101Value *InstCombiner::EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007102 bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007103 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007104 return ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(C, Ty, isSigned /*Sext or ZExt*/);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007105
7106 // Otherwise, it must be an instruction.
7107 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattner01859e82006-05-20 23:14:03 +00007108 Instruction *Res = 0;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007109 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007110 case Instruction::Add:
7111 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckye6b0c002008-01-22 05:08:48 +00007112 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007113 case Instruction::And:
7114 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007115 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007116 case Instruction::AShr:
7117 case Instruction::LShr:
7118 case Instruction::Shl: {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007119 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007120 Value *RHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007121 Res = BinaryOperator::Create((Instruction::BinaryOps)I->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007122 LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007123 break;
7124 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007125 case Instruction::Trunc:
7126 case Instruction::ZExt:
7127 case Instruction::SExt:
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007128 // If the source type of the cast is the type we're trying for then we can
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007129 // just return the source. There's no need to insert it because it is not
7130 // new.
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007131 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty)
7132 return I->getOperand(0);
7133
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007134 // Otherwise, must be the same type of cast, so just reinsert a new one.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007135 Res = CastInst::Create(cast<CastInst>(I)->getOpcode(), I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007136 Ty);
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007137 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007138 case Instruction::Select: {
7139 Value *True = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
7140 Value *False = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(2), Ty, isSigned);
7141 Res = SelectInst::Create(I->getOperand(0), True, False);
7142 break;
7143 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007144 case Instruction::PHI: {
7145 PHINode *OPN = cast<PHINode>(I);
7146 PHINode *NPN = PHINode::Create(Ty);
7147 for (unsigned i = 0, e = OPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
7148 Value *V =EvaluateInDifferentType(OPN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, isSigned);
7149 NPN->addIncoming(V, OPN->getIncomingBlock(i));
7150 }
7151 Res = NPN;
7152 break;
7153 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007154 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007155 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
7156 assert(0 && "Unreachable!");
7157 break;
7158 }
7159
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007160 Res->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007161 return InsertNewInstBefore(Res, *I);
7162}
7163
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007164/// @brief Implement the transforms common to all CastInst visitors.
7165Instruction *InstCombiner::commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner79d35b32003-06-23 21:59:52 +00007166 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7167
Dan Gohman23d9d272007-05-11 21:10:54 +00007168 // Many cases of "cast of a cast" are eliminable. If it's eliminable we just
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007169 // eliminate it now.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007170 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007171 if (Instruction::CastOps opc =
7172 isEliminableCastPair(CSrc, CI.getOpcode(), CI.getType(), TD)) {
7173 // The first cast (CSrc) is eliminable so we need to fix up or replace
7174 // the second cast (CI). CSrc will then have a good chance of being dead.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007175 return CastInst::Create(opc, CSrc->getOperand(0), CI.getType());
Chris Lattner8fd217c2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00007176 }
7177 }
Chris Lattnera710ddc2004-05-25 04:29:21 +00007178
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007179 // If we are casting a select then fold the cast into the select
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007180 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
7181 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
7182 return NV;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007183
7184 // If we are casting a PHI then fold the cast into the PHI
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00007185 if (isa<PHINode>(Src))
7186 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
7187 return NV;
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00007188
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007189 return 0;
7190}
7191
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007192/// @brief Implement the transforms for cast of pointer (bitcast/ptrtoint)
7193Instruction *InstCombiner::commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
7194 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7195
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007196 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007197 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
7198 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007199 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
7200 // Changing the cast operand is usually not a good idea but it is safe
7201 // here because the pointer operand is being replaced with another
7202 // pointer operand so the opcode doesn't need to change.
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007203 AddToWorkList(GEP);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007204 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
7205 return &CI;
7206 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007207
7208 // If the GEP has a single use, and the base pointer is a bitcast, and the
7209 // GEP computes a constant offset, see if we can convert these three
7210 // instructions into fewer. This typically happens with unions and other
7211 // non-type-safe code.
7212 if (GEP->hasOneUse() && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
7213 if (GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()) {
7214 // We are guaranteed to get a constant from EmitGEPOffset.
7215 ConstantInt *OffsetV = cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(GEP, CI, *this));
7216 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
7217
7218 // Get the base pointer input of the bitcast, and the type it points to.
7219 Value *OrigBase = cast<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))->getOperand(0);
7220 const Type *GEPIdxTy =
7221 cast<PointerType>(OrigBase->getType())->getElementType();
7222 if (GEPIdxTy->isSized()) {
7223 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
7224
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007225 // Start with the index over the outer type. Note that the type size
7226 // might be zero (even if the offset isn't zero) if the indexed type
7227 // is something like [0 x {int, int}]
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007228 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD->getIntPtrType();
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007229 int64_t FirstIdx = 0;
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007230 if (int64_t TySize = TD->getABITypeSize(GEPIdxTy)) {
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007231 FirstIdx = Offset/TySize;
7232 Offset %= TySize;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007233
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00007234 // Handle silly modulus not returning values values [0..TySize).
7235 if (Offset < 0) {
7236 --FirstIdx;
7237 Offset += TySize;
7238 assert(Offset >= 0);
7239 }
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00007240 assert((uint64_t)Offset < (uint64_t)TySize &&"Out of range offset");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007241 }
7242
7243 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, FirstIdx));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007244
7245 // Index into the types. If we fail, set OrigBase to null.
7246 while (Offset) {
7247 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
7248 const StructLayout *SL = TD->getStructLayout(STy);
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007249 if (Offset < (int64_t)SL->getSizeInBytes()) {
7250 unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(Offset);
7251 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Elt));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007252
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007253 Offset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt);
7254 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType(Elt);
7255 } else {
7256 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
7257 Offset = 0;
7258 OrigBase = 0;
7259 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007260 } else if (isa<ArrayType>(GEPIdxTy) || isa<VectorType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
7261 const SequentialType *STy = cast<SequentialType>(GEPIdxTy);
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00007262 if (uint64_t EltSize = TD->getABITypeSize(STy->getElementType())){
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00007263 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy,Offset/EltSize));
7264 Offset %= EltSize;
7265 } else {
7266 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, 0));
7267 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007268 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType();
7269 } else {
7270 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
7271 Offset = 0;
7272 OrigBase = 0;
7273 }
7274 }
7275 if (OrigBase) {
7276 // If we were able to index down into an element, create the GEP
7277 // and bitcast the result. This eliminates one bitcast, potentially
7278 // two.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00007279 Instruction *NGEP = GetElementPtrInst::Create(OrigBase,
7280 NewIndices.begin(),
7281 NewIndices.end(), "");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007282 InsertNewInstBefore(NGEP, CI);
7283 NGEP->takeName(GEP);
7284
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007285 if (isa<BitCastInst>(CI))
7286 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
7287 assert(isa<PtrToIntInst>(CI));
7288 return new PtrToIntInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
7289 }
7290 }
7291 }
7292 }
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007293 }
7294
7295 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7296}
7297
7298
7299
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007300/// Only the TRUNC, ZEXT, SEXT, and BITCAST can both operand and result as
7301/// integer types. This function implements the common transforms for all those
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007302/// cases.
7303/// @brief Implement the transforms common to CastInst with integer operands
7304Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
7305 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7306 return Result;
7307
7308 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7309 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
7310 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007311 uint32_t SrcBitSize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7312 uint32_t DestBitSize = DestTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007313
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007314 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the LHS whose sole
7315 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00007316 APInt KnownZero(DestBitSize, 0), KnownOne(DestBitSize, 0);
7317 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&CI, APInt::getAllOnesValue(DestBitSize),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007318 KnownZero, KnownOne))
7319 return &CI;
7320
7321 // If the source isn't an instruction or has more than one use then we
7322 // can't do anything more.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007323 Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src);
7324 if (!SrcI || !Src->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007325 return 0;
7326
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007327 // Attempt to propagate the cast into the instruction for int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007328 int NumCastsRemoved = 0;
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007329 if (!isa<BitCastInst>(CI) &&
7330 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, cast<IntegerType>(DestTy),
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007331 CI.getOpcode(), NumCastsRemoved)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007332 // If this cast is a truncate, evaluting in a different type always
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007333 // eliminates the cast, so it is always a win. If this is a zero-extension,
7334 // we need to do an AND to maintain the clear top-part of the computation,
7335 // so we require that the input have eliminated at least one cast. If this
7336 // is a sign extension, we insert two new casts (to do the extension) so we
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007337 // require that two casts have been eliminated.
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007338 bool DoXForm;
7339 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
7340 default:
7341 // All the others use floating point so we shouldn't actually
7342 // get here because of the check above.
7343 assert(0 && "Unknown cast type");
7344 case Instruction::Trunc:
7345 DoXForm = true;
7346 break;
7347 case Instruction::ZExt:
7348 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 1;
7349 break;
7350 case Instruction::SExt:
7351 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 2;
7352 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007353 }
7354
7355 if (DoXForm) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007356 Value *Res = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
7357 CI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007358 assert(Res->getType() == DestTy);
7359 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
7360 default: assert(0 && "Unknown cast type!");
7361 case Instruction::Trunc:
7362 case Instruction::BitCast:
7363 // Just replace this cast with the result.
7364 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
7365 case Instruction::ZExt: {
7366 // We need to emit an AND to clear the high bits.
7367 assert(SrcBitSize < DestBitSize && "Not a zext?");
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00007368 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(DestBitSize,
7369 SrcBitSize));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007370 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Res, C);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007371 }
7372 case Instruction::SExt:
7373 // We need to emit a cast to truncate, then a cast to sext.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007374 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::SExt,
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007375 InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Res, Src->getType(),
7376 CI), DestTy);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007377 }
7378 }
7379 }
7380
7381 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
7382 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
7383
7384 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
7385 case Instruction::Add:
7386 case Instruction::Mul:
7387 case Instruction::And:
7388 case Instruction::Or:
7389 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007390 // If we are discarding information, rewrite.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007391 if (DestBitSize <= SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
7392 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
7393 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
7394 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
7395 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007396 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy,TD) ||
7397 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00007398 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CI.getOpcode();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007399 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
7400 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007401 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007402 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007403 }
7404 }
7405
7406 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
7407 if (isa<ZExtInst>(CI) && SrcBitSize == 1 &&
7408 SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007409 Op1 == ConstantInt::getTrue() &&
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007410 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<CmpInst>(Op0))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007411 Value *New = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, Op0, DestTy, &CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007412 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(New, ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), 1));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007413 }
7414 break;
7415 case Instruction::SDiv:
7416 case Instruction::UDiv:
7417 case Instruction::SRem:
7418 case Instruction::URem:
7419 // If we are just changing the sign, rewrite.
7420 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize) {
7421 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
7422 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
7423 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007424 if (!ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy, TD) ||
7425 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007426 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7427 Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
7428 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7429 Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007430 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007431 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
7432 }
7433 }
7434 break;
7435
7436 case Instruction::Shl:
7437 // Allow changing the sign of the source operand. Do not allow
7438 // changing the size of the shift, UNLESS the shift amount is a
7439 // constant. We must not change variable sized shifts to a smaller
7440 // size, because it is undefined to shift more bits out than exist
7441 // in the value.
7442 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
7443 (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && isa<Constant>(Op1))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007444 Instruction::CastOps opcode = (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ?
7445 Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc);
7446 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007447 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007448 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007449 }
7450 break;
7451 case Instruction::AShr:
7452 // If this is a signed shr, and if all bits shifted in are about to be
7453 // truncated off, turn it into an unsigned shr to allow greater
7454 // simplifications.
7455 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize &&
7456 isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007457 uint32_t ShiftAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)->getLimitedValue(SrcBitSize);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007458 if (SrcBitSize > ShiftAmt && SrcBitSize-ShiftAmt >= DestBitSize) {
7459 // Insert the new logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007460 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, Op1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007461 }
7462 }
7463 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007464 }
7465 return 0;
7466}
7467
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007468Instruction *InstCombiner::visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007469 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7470 return Result;
7471
7472 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7473 const Type *Ty = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007474 uint32_t DestBitWidth = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7475 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007476
7477 if (Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src)) {
7478 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
7479 default: break;
7480 case Instruction::LShr:
7481 // We can shrink lshr to something smaller if we know the bits shifted in
7482 // are already zeros.
7483 if (ConstantInt *ShAmtV = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007484 uint32_t ShAmt = ShAmtV->getLimitedValue(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007485
7486 // Get a mask for the bits shifting in.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00007487 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcBitWidth, ShAmt).shl(DestBitWidth));
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007488 Value* SrcIOp0 = SrcI->getOperand(0);
7489 if (SrcI->hasOneUse() && MaskedValueIsZero(SrcIOp0, Mask)) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007490 if (ShAmt >= DestBitWidth) // All zeros.
7491 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Constant::getNullValue(Ty));
7492
7493 // Okay, we can shrink this. Truncate the input, then return a new
7494 // shift.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007495 Value *V1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcIOp0, Ty, CI);
7496 Value *V2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcI->getOperand(1),
7497 Ty, CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007498 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(V1, V2);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007499 }
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007500 } else { // This is a variable shr.
7501
7502 // Turn 'trunc (lshr X, Y) to bool' into '(X & (1 << Y)) != 0'. This is
7503 // more LLVM instructions, but allows '1 << Y' to be hoisted if
7504 // loop-invariant and CSE'd.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007505 if (CI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty && SrcI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007506 Value *One = ConstantInt::get(SrcI->getType(), 1);
7507
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007508 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007509 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(One, SrcI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007510 "tmp"), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007511 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V,
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007512 SrcI->getOperand(0),
7513 "tmp"), CI);
7514 Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(V->getType());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007515 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, Zero);
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00007516 }
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007517 }
7518 break;
7519 }
7520 }
7521
7522 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007523}
7524
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007525/// transformZExtICmp - Transform (zext icmp) to bitwise / integer operations
7526/// in order to eliminate the icmp.
7527Instruction *InstCombiner::transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
7528 bool DoXform) {
7529 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
7530 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
7531 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
7532 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
7533 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
7534
7535 // zext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>u31 true if signbit set.
7536 // zext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>u31)^1 true if signbit clear.
7537 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
7538 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
7539 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
7540
7541 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7542 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
7543 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007544 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In, Sh,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007545 In->getName()+".lobit"),
7546 CI);
7547 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007548 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007549 false/*ZExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
7550
7551 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) {
7552 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007553 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007554 In->getName()+".not"),
7555 CI);
7556 }
7557
7558 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7559 }
7560
7561
7562
7563 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
7564 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7565 // zext (X == 1) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
7566 // zext (X == 2) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7567 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
7568 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7569 // zext (X != 1) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
7570 // zext (X != 2) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
7571 if ((Op1CV == 0 || Op1CV.isPowerOf2()) &&
7572 // This only works for EQ and NE
7573 ICI->isEquality()) {
7574 // If Op1C some other power of two, convert:
7575 uint32_t BitWidth = Op1C->getType()->getBitWidth();
7576 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
7577 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
7578 ComputeMaskedBits(ICI->getOperand(0), TypeMask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
7579
7580 APInt KnownZeroMask(~KnownZero);
7581 if (KnownZeroMask.isPowerOf2()) { // Exactly 1 possible 1?
7582 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
7583
7584 bool isNE = ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
7585 if (Op1CV != 0 && (Op1CV != KnownZeroMask)) {
7586 // (X&4) == 2 --> false
7587 // (X&4) != 2 --> true
7588 Constant *Res = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, isNE);
7589 Res = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Res, CI.getType());
7590 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
7591 }
7592
7593 uint32_t ShiftAmt = KnownZeroMask.logBase2();
7594 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7595 if (ShiftAmt) {
7596 // Perform a logical shr by shiftamt.
7597 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007598 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007599 ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), ShiftAmt),
7600 In->getName()+".lobit"), CI);
7601 }
7602
7603 if ((Op1CV != 0) == isNE) { // Toggle the low bit.
7604 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007605 In = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One, "tmp");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007606 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(In), CI);
7607 }
7608
7609 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
7610 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7611 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007612 return CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007613 }
7614 }
7615 }
7616
7617 return 0;
7618}
7619
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007620Instruction *InstCombiner::visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007621 // If one of the common conversion will work ..
7622 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7623 return Result;
7624
7625 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7626
7627 // If this is a cast of a cast
7628 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007629 // If this is a TRUNC followed by a ZEXT then we are dealing with integral
7630 // types and if the sizes are just right we can convert this into a logical
7631 // 'and' which will be much cheaper than the pair of casts.
7632 if (isa<TruncInst>(CSrc)) {
7633 // Get the sizes of the types involved
7634 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007635 uint32_t SrcSize = A->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7636 uint32_t MidSize = CSrc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7637 uint32_t DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007638 // If we're actually extending zero bits and the trunc is a no-op
7639 if (MidSize < DstSize && SrcSize == DstSize) {
7640 // Replace both of the casts with an And of the type mask.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00007641 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00007642 Constant *AndConst = ConstantInt::get(AndValue);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007643 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007644 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CSrc->getOperand(0), AndConst);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007645 // Unfortunately, if the type changed, we need to cast it back.
7646 if (And->getType() != CI.getType()) {
7647 And->setName(CSrc->getName()+".mask");
7648 InsertNewInstBefore(And, CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007649 And = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(And, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007650 }
7651 return And;
7652 }
7653 }
7654 }
7655
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007656 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src))
7657 return transformZExtICmp(ICI, CI);
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00007658
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007659 BinaryOperator *SrcI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Src);
7660 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
7661 // zext (or icmp, icmp) --> or (zext icmp), (zext icmp) if at least one
7662 // of the (zext icmp) will be transformed.
7663 ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(0));
7664 ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(1));
7665 if (LHS && RHS && LHS->hasOneUse() && RHS->hasOneUse() &&
7666 (transformZExtICmp(LHS, CI, false) ||
7667 transformZExtICmp(RHS, CI, false))) {
7668 Value *LCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, LHS, CI.getType(), CI);
7669 Value *RCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, RHS, CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007670 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::Or, LCast, RCast);
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00007671 }
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00007672 }
7673
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007674 return 0;
7675}
7676
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007677Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSExt(SExtInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007678 if (Instruction *I = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7679 return I;
7680
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007681 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7682
7683 // sext (x <s 0) -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if signed
7684 // sext (x >s -1) -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if not signed
7685 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src)) {
7686 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
7687 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
7688 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
7689 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
7690 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
7691
7692 // sext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>s31 true if signbit set.
7693 // sext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>s31)^-1 true if signbit clear.
7694 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
7695 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())){
7696 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
7697 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
7698 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007699 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(In, Sh,
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00007700 In->getName()+".lobit"),
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007701 CI);
7702 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007703 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007704 true/*SExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
7705
7706 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007707 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(In,
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007708 In->getName()+".not"), CI);
7709
7710 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
7711 }
7712 }
7713 }
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00007714
7715 // See if the value being truncated is already sign extended. If so, just
7716 // eliminate the trunc/sext pair.
7717 if (getOpcode(Src) == Instruction::Trunc) {
7718 Value *Op = cast<User>(Src)->getOperand(0);
7719 unsigned OpBits = cast<IntegerType>(Op->getType())->getBitWidth();
7720 unsigned MidBits = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
7721 unsigned DestBits = cast<IntegerType>(CI.getType())->getBitWidth();
7722 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Op);
7723
7724 if (OpBits == DestBits) {
7725 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 24 sign
7726 // bits, it is already ready.
7727 if (NumSignBits > DestBits-MidBits)
7728 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Op);
7729 } else if (OpBits < DestBits) {
7730 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i64. If Op has more than 24 sign
7731 // bits, just sext from i32.
7732 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
7733 return new SExtInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
7734 } else {
7735 // Op is i64, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 56 sign
7736 // bits, just truncate to i32.
7737 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
7738 return new TruncInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
7739 }
7740 }
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00007741
7742 // If the input is a shl/ashr pair of a same constant, then this is a sign
7743 // extension from a smaller value. If we could trust arbitrary bitwidth
7744 // integers, we could turn this into a truncate to the smaller bit and then
7745 // use a sext for the whole extension. Since we don't, look deeper and check
7746 // for a truncate. If the source and dest are the same type, eliminate the
7747 // trunc and extend and just do shifts. For example, turn:
7748 // %a = trunc i32 %i to i8
7749 // %b = shl i8 %a, 6
7750 // %c = ashr i8 %b, 6
7751 // %d = sext i8 %c to i32
7752 // into:
7753 // %a = shl i32 %i, 30
7754 // %d = ashr i32 %a, 30
7755 Value *A = 0;
7756 ConstantInt *BA = 0, *CA = 0;
7757 if (match(Src, m_AShr(m_Shl(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(BA)),
7758 m_ConstantInt(CA))) &&
7759 BA == CA && isa<TruncInst>(A)) {
7760 Value *I = cast<TruncInst>(A)->getOperand(0);
7761 if (I->getType() == CI.getType()) {
7762 unsigned MidSize = Src->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7763 unsigned SrcDstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7764 unsigned ShAmt = CA->getZExtValue()+SrcDstSize-MidSize;
7765 Constant *ShAmtV = ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), ShAmt);
7766 I = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I, ShAmtV,
7767 CI.getName()), CI);
7768 return BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(I, ShAmtV);
7769 }
7770 }
7771
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007772 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007773}
7774
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007775/// FitsInFPType - Return a Constant* for the specified FP constant if it fits
7776/// in the specified FP type without changing its value.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00007777static Constant *FitsInFPType(ConstantFP *CFP, const fltSemantics &Sem) {
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007778 APFloat F = CFP->getValueAPF();
7779 if (F.convert(Sem, APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven) == APFloat::opOK)
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00007780 return ConstantFP::get(F);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007781 return 0;
7782}
7783
7784/// LookThroughFPExtensions - If this is an fp extension instruction, look
7785/// through it until we get the source value.
7786static Value *LookThroughFPExtensions(Value *V) {
7787 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
7788 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::FPExt)
7789 return LookThroughFPExtensions(I->getOperand(0));
7790
7791 // If this value is a constant, return the constant in the smallest FP type
7792 // that can accurately represent it. This allows us to turn
7793 // (float)((double)X+2.0) into x+2.0f.
7794 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(V)) {
7795 if (CFP->getType() == Type::PPC_FP128Ty)
7796 return V; // No constant folding of this.
7797 // See if the value can be truncated to float and then reextended.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00007798 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEsingle))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007799 return V;
7800 if (CFP->getType() == Type::DoubleTy)
7801 return V; // Won't shrink.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00007802 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEdouble))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007803 return V;
7804 // Don't try to shrink to various long double types.
7805 }
7806
7807 return V;
7808}
7809
7810Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI) {
7811 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7812 return I;
7813
7814 // If we have fptrunc(add (fpextend x), (fpextend y)), where x and y are
7815 // smaller than the destination type, we can eliminate the truncate by doing
7816 // the add as the smaller type. This applies to add/sub/mul/div as well as
7817 // many builtins (sqrt, etc).
7818 BinaryOperator *OpI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(CI.getOperand(0));
7819 if (OpI && OpI->hasOneUse()) {
7820 switch (OpI->getOpcode()) {
7821 default: break;
7822 case Instruction::Add:
7823 case Instruction::Sub:
7824 case Instruction::Mul:
7825 case Instruction::FDiv:
7826 case Instruction::FRem:
7827 const Type *SrcTy = OpI->getType();
7828 Value *LHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(0));
7829 Value *RHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(1));
7830 if (LHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy &&
7831 RHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy) {
7832 unsigned DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7833 // If the source types were both smaller than the destination type of
7834 // the cast, do this xform.
7835 if (LHSTrunc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <= DstSize &&
7836 RHSTrunc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <= DstSize) {
7837 LHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, LHSTrunc,
7838 CI.getType(), CI);
7839 RHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, RHSTrunc,
7840 CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007841 return BinaryOperator::Create(OpI->getOpcode(), LHSTrunc, RHSTrunc);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00007842 }
7843 }
7844 break;
7845 }
7846 }
7847 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007848}
7849
7850Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPExt(CastInst &CI) {
7851 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7852}
7853
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00007854Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00007855 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
7856 if (OpI == 0)
7857 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
7858
7859 // fptoui(uitofp(X)) --> X
7860 // fptoui(sitofp(X)) --> X
7861 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
7862 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
7863 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
7864 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
7865 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
7866 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
7867 (int)FI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() < /*extra bit for sign */
7868 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
7869 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00007870
7871 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007872}
7873
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00007874Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00007875 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
7876 if (OpI == 0)
7877 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
7878
7879 // fptosi(sitofp(X)) --> X
7880 // fptosi(uitofp(X)) --> X
7881 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
7882 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
7883 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
7884 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
7885 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
7886 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
7887 (int)FI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <=
7888 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
7889 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00007890
7891 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007892}
7893
7894Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
7895 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7896}
7897
7898Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
7899 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7900}
7901
7902Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007903 return commonPointerCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007904}
7905
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00007906Instruction *InstCombiner::visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI) {
7907 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7908 return I;
7909
7910 const Type *DestPointee = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType())->getElementType();
7911 if (!DestPointee->isSized()) return 0;
7912
7913 // If this is inttoptr(add (ptrtoint x), cst), try to turn this into a GEP.
7914 ConstantInt *Cst;
7915 Value *X;
7916 if (match(CI.getOperand(0), m_Add(m_Cast<PtrToIntInst>(m_Value(X)),
7917 m_ConstantInt(Cst)))) {
7918 // If the source and destination operands have the same type, see if this
7919 // is a single-index GEP.
7920 if (X->getType() == CI.getType()) {
7921 // Get the size of the pointee type.
Bill Wendlingb9d4f8d2008-03-14 05:12:19 +00007922 uint64_t Size = TD->getABITypeSize(DestPointee);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00007923
7924 // Convert the constant to intptr type.
7925 APInt Offset = Cst->getValue();
7926 Offset.sextOrTrunc(TD->getPointerSizeInBits());
7927
7928 // If Offset is evenly divisible by Size, we can do this xform.
7929 if (Size && !APIntOps::srem(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size))){
7930 Offset = APIntOps::sdiv(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size));
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00007931 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, ConstantInt::get(Offset));
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00007932 }
7933 }
7934 // TODO: Could handle other cases, e.g. where add is indexing into field of
7935 // struct etc.
7936 } else if (CI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
7937 match(CI.getOperand(0), m_Add(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(Cst)))) {
7938 // Otherwise, if this is inttoptr(add x, cst), try to turn this into an
7939 // "inttoptr+GEP" instead of "add+intptr".
7940
7941 // Get the size of the pointee type.
7942 uint64_t Size = TD->getABITypeSize(DestPointee);
7943
7944 // Convert the constant to intptr type.
7945 APInt Offset = Cst->getValue();
7946 Offset.sextOrTrunc(TD->getPointerSizeInBits());
7947
7948 // If Offset is evenly divisible by Size, we can do this xform.
7949 if (Size && !APIntOps::srem(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size))){
7950 Offset = APIntOps::sdiv(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size));
7951
7952 Instruction *P = InsertNewInstBefore(new IntToPtrInst(X, CI.getType(),
7953 "tmp"), CI);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00007954 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(P, ConstantInt::get(Offset), "tmp");
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00007955 }
7956 }
7957 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007958}
7959
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007960Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007961 // If the operands are integer typed then apply the integer transforms,
7962 // otherwise just apply the common ones.
7963 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7964 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
7965 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
7966
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00007967 if (SrcTy->isInteger() && DestTy->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007968 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7969 return Result;
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007970 } else if (isa<PointerType>(SrcTy)) {
7971 if (Instruction *I = commonPointerCastTransforms(CI))
7972 return I;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007973 } else {
7974 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7975 return Result;
7976 }
7977
7978
7979 // Get rid of casts from one type to the same type. These are useless and can
7980 // be replaced by the operand.
7981 if (DestTy == Src->getType())
7982 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
7983
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007984 if (const PointerType *DstPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(DestTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007985 const PointerType *SrcPTy = cast<PointerType>(SrcTy);
7986 const Type *DstElTy = DstPTy->getElementType();
7987 const Type *SrcElTy = SrcPTy->getElementType();
7988
Nate Begeman83ad90a2008-03-31 00:22:16 +00007989 // If the address spaces don't match, don't eliminate the bitcast, which is
7990 // required for changing types.
7991 if (SrcPTy->getAddressSpace() != DstPTy->getAddressSpace())
7992 return 0;
7993
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007994 // If we are casting a malloc or alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
7995 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
7996 if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(Src))
7997 if (Instruction *V = PromoteCastOfAllocation(CI, *AI))
7998 return V;
7999
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00008000 // If the source and destination are pointers, and this cast is equivalent
8001 // to a getelementptr X, 0, 0, 0... turn it into the appropriate gep.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008002 // This can enhance SROA and other transforms that want type-safe pointers.
8003 Constant *ZeroUInt = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
8004 unsigned NumZeros = 0;
8005 while (SrcElTy != DstElTy &&
8006 isa<CompositeType>(SrcElTy) && !isa<PointerType>(SrcElTy) &&
8007 SrcElTy->getNumContainedTypes() /* not "{}" */) {
8008 SrcElTy = cast<CompositeType>(SrcElTy)->getTypeAtIndex(ZeroUInt);
8009 ++NumZeros;
8010 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00008011
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008012 // If we found a path from the src to dest, create the getelementptr now.
8013 if (SrcElTy == DstElTy) {
8014 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Idxs(NumZeros+1, ZeroUInt);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008015 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(Src, Idxs.begin(), Idxs.end(), "",
8016 ((Instruction*) NULL));
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00008017 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008018 }
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +00008019
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008020 if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Src)) {
8021 if (SVI->hasOneUse()) {
8022 // Okay, we have (bitconvert (shuffle ..)). Check to see if this is
8023 // a bitconvert to a vector with the same # elts.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008024 if (isa<VectorType>(DestTy) &&
8025 cast<VectorType>(DestTy)->getNumElements() ==
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008026 SVI->getType()->getNumElements()) {
8027 CastInst *Tmp;
8028 // If either of the operands is a cast from CI.getType(), then
8029 // evaluating the shuffle in the casted destination's type will allow
8030 // us to eliminate at least one cast.
8031 if (((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(0))) &&
8032 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy) ||
8033 ((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(1))) &&
8034 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008035 Value *LHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
8036 SVI->getOperand(0), DestTy, &CI);
8037 Value *RHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
8038 SVI->getOperand(1), DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008039 // Return a new shuffle vector. Use the same element ID's, as we
8040 // know the vector types match #elts.
8041 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +00008042 }
8043 }
8044 }
8045 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00008046 return 0;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00008047}
8048
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008049/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
8050/// %C = or %A, %B
8051/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
8052/// into:
8053/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
8054/// %D = or %A, %C
8055///
8056/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
8057/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
8058/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
8059///
8060static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
8061 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
8062 case Instruction::Add:
8063 case Instruction::Mul:
8064 case Instruction::And:
8065 case Instruction::Or:
8066 case Instruction::Xor:
8067 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
8068 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
8069 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00008070 case Instruction::LShr:
8071 case Instruction::AShr:
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008072 return 1;
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008073 default:
8074 return 0; // Cannot fold
8075 }
8076}
8077
8078/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
8079/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
8080static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I) {
8081 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
8082 default: assert(0 && "This cannot happen!"); abort();
8083 case Instruction::Add:
8084 case Instruction::Sub:
8085 case Instruction::Or:
8086 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008087 case Instruction::Shl:
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00008088 case Instruction::LShr:
8089 case Instruction::AShr:
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008090 return Constant::getNullValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008091 case Instruction::And:
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00008092 return Constant::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008093 case Instruction::Mul:
8094 return ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), 1);
8095 }
8096}
8097
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008098/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
8099/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
8100Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
8101 Instruction *FI) {
8102 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
8103 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
8104 // merge.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008105 if (TI->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008106 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
8107 return 0;
8108 } else {
8109 return 0; // unknown unary op.
8110 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008111
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008112 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008113 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
8114 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008115 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008116 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008117 TI->getType());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008118 }
8119
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008120 // Only handle binary operators here.
8121 if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008122 return 0;
8123
8124 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
8125 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
8126 bool MatchIsOpZero;
8127 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
8128 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
8129 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
8130 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
8131 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8132 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
8133 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
8134 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
8135 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
8136 MatchIsOpZero = false;
8137 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
8138 return 0;
8139 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
8140 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
8141 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
8142 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
8143 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8144 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
8145 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
8146 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
8147 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
8148 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8149 } else {
8150 return 0;
8151 }
8152
8153 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008154 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
8155 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008156 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
8157
8158 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
8159 if (MatchIsOpZero)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008160 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008161 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008162 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008163 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00008164 assert(0 && "Shouldn't get here");
8165 return 0;
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008166}
8167
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008168Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008169 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
8170 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
8171 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
8172
8173 // select true, X, Y -> X
8174 // select false, X, Y -> Y
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008175 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008176 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008177
8178 // select C, X, X -> X
8179 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
8180 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8181
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008182 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
8183 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8184 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
8185 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8186 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
8187 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
8188 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8189 else
8190 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8191 }
8192
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00008193 if (SI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008194 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008195 if (C->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008196 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008197 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008198 } else {
8199 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
8200 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008201 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008202 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008203 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008204 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008205 } else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008206 if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008207 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008208 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008209 } else {
8210 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
8211 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008212 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008213 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008214 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008215 }
8216 }
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00008217
8218 // select a, b, a -> a&b
8219 // select a, a, b -> a|b
8220 if (CondVal == TrueVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008221 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00008222 else if (CondVal == FalseVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008223 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008224 }
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008225
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00008226 // Selecting between two integer constants?
8227 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
8228 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008229 // select C, 1, 0 -> zext C to int
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008230 if (FalseValC->isZero() && TrueValC->getValue() == 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008231 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008232 } else if (TrueValC->isZero() && FalseValC->getValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008233 // select C, 0, 1 -> zext !C to int
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00008234 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008235 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00008236 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008237 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00008238 }
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008239
8240 // FIXME: Turn select 0/-1 and -1/0 into sext from condition!
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008241
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008242 if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008243
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008244 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008245 if (TrueValC->isAllOnesValue() && FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008246 if (ConstantInt *CmpCst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008247 if (IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && CmpCst->isZero()) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008248 // The comparison constant and the result are not neccessarily the
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008249 // same width. Make an all-ones value by inserting a AShr.
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008250 Value *X = IC->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008251 uint32_t Bits = X->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008252 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantInt::get(X->getType(), Bits-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008253 Instruction *SRA = BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr, X,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008254 ShAmt, "ones");
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008255 InsertNewInstBefore(SRA, SI);
8256
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008257 // Finally, convert to the type of the select RHS. We figure out
8258 // if this requires a SExt, Trunc or BitCast based on the sizes.
8259 Instruction::CastOps opc = Instruction::BitCast;
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008260 uint32_t SRASize = SRA->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8261 uint32_t SISize = SI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008262 if (SRASize < SISize)
8263 opc = Instruction::SExt;
8264 else if (SRASize > SISize)
8265 opc = Instruction::Trunc;
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008266 return CastInst::Create(opc, SRA, SI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008267 }
8268 }
8269
8270
8271 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008272 // have an icmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008273 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
8274 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008275 if (TrueValC->isZero() || FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00008276 if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008277 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
8278 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
8279 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008280 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
8281 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
8282 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008283 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
8284 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008285 // know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
8286 // true or false val is the zero.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008287 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isZero();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008288 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008289 Value *V = ICA;
8290 if (ShouldNotVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008291 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008292 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
8293 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
8294 }
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008295 }
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008296 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008297
8298 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008299 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
8300 if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008301 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008302 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
8303 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
8304 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
8305 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
8306 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
8307 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
8308 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
8309 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
8310 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008311 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008312 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008313 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008314 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008315 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8316 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
8317
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008318 } else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008319 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008320 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
8321 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
8322 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
8323 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
8324 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
8325 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
8326 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
8327 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
8328 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
8329 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8330 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008331 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008332 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
8333 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8334 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
8335 }
8336 }
8337
8338 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
8339 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal)) {
8340 if (ICI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && ICI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
8341 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
8342 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
8343 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8344 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
8345 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
8346 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8347 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
8348
8349 } else if (ICI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && ICI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
8350 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
8351 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
8352 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8353 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
8354 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Chris Lattnerfbede522004-04-11 01:39:19 +00008355 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008356 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
8357 }
8358 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008359
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008360 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
8361 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
8362 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008363 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
8364
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008365 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
8366 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
8367 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
8368 return IV;
8369
8370 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
8371 // even legal for FP.
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008372 if (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
8373 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
8374 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
8375 } else if (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
8376 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
8377 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
8378 }
8379
8380 if (AddOp) {
8381 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
8382 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
8383 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
8384 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
8385 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
8386 }
8387
8388 if (OtherAddOp) {
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008389 // So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
8390 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
8391 Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
8392 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
8393 NegVal = ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
8394 } else {
8395 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008396 BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(SubOp->getOperand(1), "tmp"), SI);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008397 }
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008398
8399 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
8400 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
8401 if (AddOp != TI)
8402 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
8403 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008404 SelectInst::Create(CondVal, NewTrueOp,
8405 NewFalseOp, SI.getName() + ".p");
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008406
8407 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008408 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008409 }
8410 }
8411 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008412
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008413 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00008414 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008415 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
8416 // transformation we are doing here.
8417 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
8418 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
8419 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal))
8420 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
8421 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
8422 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
8423 OpToFold = 1;
8424 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
8425 OpToFold = 2;
8426 }
8427
8428 if (OpToFold) {
8429 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008430 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008431 SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(),
8432 TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold), C);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008433 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008434 NewSel->takeName(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008435 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008436 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008437 else {
8438 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
8439 }
8440 }
8441 }
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00008442
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008443 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
8444 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
8445 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
8446 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
8447 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
8448 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
8449 OpToFold = 1;
8450 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
8451 OpToFold = 2;
8452 }
8453
8454 if (OpToFold) {
8455 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008456 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008457 SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), C,
8458 FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold));
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008459 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008460 NewSel->takeName(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008461 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008462 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008463 else
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008464 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008465 }
8466 }
8467 }
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00008468
8469 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
8470 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
8471 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
8472 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
8473 return &SI;
8474 }
8475
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008476 return 0;
8477}
8478
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008479/// EnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer points to an object that
8480/// we control, modify the object's alignment to PrefAlign. This isn't
8481/// often possible though. If alignment is important, a more reliable approach
8482/// is to simply align all global variables and allocation instructions to
8483/// their preferred alignment from the beginning.
8484///
8485static unsigned EnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
8486 unsigned Align, unsigned PrefAlign) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008487
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008488 User *U = dyn_cast<User>(V);
8489 if (!U) return Align;
8490
8491 switch (getOpcode(U)) {
8492 default: break;
8493 case Instruction::BitCast:
8494 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
8495 case Instruction::GetElementPtr: {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008496 // If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
8497 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
Gabor Greif52ed3632008-06-12 21:51:29 +00008498 for (User::op_iterator i = U->op_begin() + 1, e = U->op_end(); i != e; ++i)
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00008499 if (!isa<Constant>(*i) ||
8500 !cast<Constant>(*i)->isNullValue()) {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008501 AllZeroOperands = false;
8502 break;
8503 }
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008504
8505 if (AllZeroOperands) {
8506 // Treat this like a bitcast.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008507 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008508 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008509 break;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008510 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008511 }
8512
8513 if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(V)) {
8514 // If there is a large requested alignment and we can, bump up the alignment
8515 // of the global.
8516 if (!GV->isDeclaration()) {
8517 GV->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
8518 Align = PrefAlign;
8519 }
8520 } else if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(V)) {
8521 // If there is a requested alignment and if this is an alloca, round up. We
8522 // don't do this for malloc, because some systems can't respect the request.
8523 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI)) {
8524 AI->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
8525 Align = PrefAlign;
8526 }
8527 }
8528
8529 return Align;
8530}
8531
8532/// GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that
8533/// we can determine, return it, otherwise return 0. If PrefAlign is specified,
8534/// and it is more than the alignment of the ultimate object, see if we can
8535/// increase the alignment of the ultimate object, making this check succeed.
8536unsigned InstCombiner::GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
8537 unsigned PrefAlign) {
8538 unsigned BitWidth = TD ? TD->getTypeSizeInBits(V->getType()) :
8539 sizeof(PrefAlign) * CHAR_BIT;
8540 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
8541 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
8542 ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
8543 unsigned TrailZ = KnownZero.countTrailingOnes();
8544 unsigned Align = 1u << std::min(BitWidth - 1, TrailZ);
8545
8546 if (PrefAlign > Align)
8547 Align = EnforceKnownAlignment(V, Align, PrefAlign);
8548
8549 // We don't need to make any adjustment.
8550 return Align;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008551}
8552
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008553Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI) {
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00008554 unsigned DstAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1));
8555 unsigned SrcAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008556 unsigned MinAlign = std::min(DstAlign, SrcAlign);
8557 unsigned CopyAlign = MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue();
8558
8559 if (CopyAlign < MinAlign) {
8560 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, MinAlign));
8561 return MI;
8562 }
8563
8564 // If MemCpyInst length is 1/2/4/8 bytes then replace memcpy with
8565 // load/store.
8566 ConstantInt *MemOpLength = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getOperand(3));
8567 if (MemOpLength == 0) return 0;
8568
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008569 // Source and destination pointer types are always "i8*" for intrinsic. See
8570 // if the size is something we can handle with a single primitive load/store.
8571 // A single load+store correctly handles overlapping memory in the memmove
8572 // case.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008573 unsigned Size = MemOpLength->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00008574 if (Size == 0) return MI; // Delete this mem transfer.
8575
8576 if (Size > 8 || (Size&(Size-1)))
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008577 return 0; // If not 1/2/4/8 bytes, exit.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008578
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008579 // Use an integer load+store unless we can find something better.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008580 Type *NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(IntegerType::get(Size<<3));
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008581
8582 // Memcpy forces the use of i8* for the source and destination. That means
8583 // that if you're using memcpy to move one double around, you'll get a cast
8584 // from double* to i8*. We'd much rather use a double load+store rather than
8585 // an i64 load+store, here because this improves the odds that the source or
8586 // dest address will be promotable. See if we can find a better type than the
8587 // integer datatype.
8588 if (Value *Op = getBitCastOperand(MI->getOperand(1))) {
8589 const Type *SrcETy = cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getElementType();
8590 if (SrcETy->isSized() && TD->getTypeStoreSize(SrcETy) == Size) {
8591 // The SrcETy might be something like {{{double}}} or [1 x double]. Rip
8592 // down through these levels if so.
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00008593 while (!SrcETy->isSingleValueType()) {
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008594 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(SrcETy)) {
8595 if (STy->getNumElements() == 1)
8596 SrcETy = STy->getElementType(0);
8597 else
8598 break;
8599 } else if (const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcETy)) {
8600 if (ATy->getNumElements() == 1)
8601 SrcETy = ATy->getElementType();
8602 else
8603 break;
8604 } else
8605 break;
8606 }
8607
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00008608 if (SrcETy->isSingleValueType())
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008609 NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(SrcETy);
8610 }
8611 }
8612
8613
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008614 // If the memcpy/memmove provides better alignment info than we can
8615 // infer, use it.
8616 SrcAlign = std::max(SrcAlign, CopyAlign);
8617 DstAlign = std::max(DstAlign, CopyAlign);
8618
8619 Value *Src = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(2), NewPtrTy, *MI);
8620 Value *Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(1), NewPtrTy, *MI);
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00008621 Instruction *L = new LoadInst(Src, "tmp", false, SrcAlign);
8622 InsertNewInstBefore(L, *MI);
8623 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(L, Dest, false, DstAlign), *MI);
8624
8625 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
8626 MI->setOperand(3, Constant::getNullValue(MemOpLength->getType()));
8627 return MI;
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008628}
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008629
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00008630Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI) {
8631 unsigned Alignment = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getDest());
8632 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Alignment) {
8633 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Alignment));
8634 return MI;
8635 }
8636
8637 // Extract the length and alignment and fill if they are constant.
8638 ConstantInt *LenC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getLength());
8639 ConstantInt *FillC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getValue());
8640 if (!LenC || !FillC || FillC->getType() != Type::Int8Ty)
8641 return 0;
8642 uint64_t Len = LenC->getZExtValue();
8643 Alignment = MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue();
8644
8645 // If the length is zero, this is a no-op
8646 if (Len == 0) return MI; // memset(d,c,0,a) -> noop
8647
8648 // memset(s,c,n) -> store s, c (for n=1,2,4,8)
8649 if (Len <= 8 && isPowerOf2_32((uint32_t)Len)) {
8650 const Type *ITy = IntegerType::get(Len*8); // n=1 -> i8.
8651
8652 Value *Dest = MI->getDest();
8653 Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(Dest, PointerType::getUnqual(ITy), *MI);
8654
8655 // Alignment 0 is identity for alignment 1 for memset, but not store.
8656 if (Alignment == 0) Alignment = 1;
8657
8658 // Extract the fill value and store.
8659 uint64_t Fill = FillC->getZExtValue()*0x0101010101010101ULL;
8660 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(ConstantInt::get(ITy, Fill), Dest, false,
8661 Alignment), *MI);
8662
8663 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
8664 MI->setLength(Constant::getNullValue(LenC->getType()));
8665 return MI;
8666 }
8667
8668 return 0;
8669}
8670
8671
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00008672/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
8673/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
8674/// the heavy lifting.
8675///
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008676Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00008677 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
8678 if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
8679
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00008680 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
8681 // visitCallSite.
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00008682 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008683 bool Changed = false;
8684
8685 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
8686 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
8687 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
8688
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008689 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008690 if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008691 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
8692 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
8693 // alignment is sufficient.
8694 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00008695 }
8696
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008697 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
8698 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
8699 // into a call to memcpy.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008700 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008701 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
8702 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
8703 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00008704 Intrinsic::ID MemCpyID;
8705 if (CI.getOperand(3)->getType() == Type::Int32Ty)
8706 MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy_i32;
Chris Lattner21959392006-03-03 01:34:17 +00008707 else
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00008708 MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy_i64;
8709 CI.setOperand(0, Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, MemCpyID));
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008710 Changed = true;
8711 }
Chris Lattnera935db82008-05-28 05:30:41 +00008712
8713 // memmove(x,x,size) -> noop.
8714 if (MMI->getSource() == MMI->getDest())
8715 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008716 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008717
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008718 // If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
8719 // set, update the alignment.
8720 if (isa<MemCpyInst>(MI) || isa<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00008721 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemTransfer(MI))
8722 return I;
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00008723 } else if (MemSetInst *MSI = dyn_cast<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
8724 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemSet(MSI))
8725 return I;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00008726 }
8727
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00008728 if (Changed) return II;
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008729 }
8730
8731 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
8732 default: break;
8733 case Intrinsic::bswap:
8734 // bswap(bswap(x)) -> x
8735 if (IntrinsicInst *Operand = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1)))
8736 if (Operand->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap)
8737 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Operand->getOperand(1));
8738 break;
8739 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
8740 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
8741 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
8742 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
8743 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
8744 // Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
8745 // Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
8746 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
8747 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),
8748 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getType()),
8749 CI);
8750 return new LoadInst(Ptr);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00008751 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008752 break;
8753 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
8754 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
8755 // Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
8756 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), 16) >= 16) {
8757 const Type *OpPtrTy =
8758 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
8759 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2), OpPtrTy, CI);
8760 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
8761 }
8762 break;
8763 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
8764 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
8765 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008766 // Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
8767 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
8768 const Type *OpPtrTy =
8769 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
8770 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1), OpPtrTy, CI);
8771 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
8772 }
8773 break;
8774
8775 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
8776 // These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
8777 // we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
8778 uint64_t UndefElts;
8779 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), 1,
8780 UndefElts)) {
8781 II->setOperand(1, V);
8782 return II;
8783 }
8784 break;
8785 }
8786
8787 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
8788 // Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
8789 if (ConstantVector *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(II->getOperand(3))) {
8790 assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00008791
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008792 // Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
8793 bool AllEltsOk = true;
8794 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
8795 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
8796 !isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
8797 AllEltsOk = false;
8798 break;
8799 }
8800 }
8801
8802 if (AllEltsOk) {
8803 // Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
8804 Value *Op0 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),Mask->getType(),CI);
8805 Value *Op1 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2),Mask->getType(),CI);
8806 Value *Result = UndefValue::get(Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008807
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008808 // Only extract each element once.
8809 Value *ExtractedElts[32];
8810 memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
8811
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008812 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008813 if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
8814 continue;
8815 unsigned Idx=cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
8816 Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
8817
8818 if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
8819 Instruction *Elt =
8820 new ExtractElementInst(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1, Idx&15, "tmp");
8821 InsertNewInstBefore(Elt, CI);
8822 ExtractedElts[Idx] = Elt;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008823 }
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008824
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008825 // Insert this value into the result vector.
8826 Result = InsertElementInst::Create(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx],
8827 i, "tmp");
8828 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Result), CI);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008829 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008830 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008831 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008832 }
8833 break;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00008834
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008835 case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
8836 // If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
8837 // happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
8838 if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
8839 if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
8840 BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
8841 if (&*++BI == II)
8842 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00008843 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008844 }
8845
8846 // Scan down this block to see if there is another stack restore in the
8847 // same block without an intervening call/alloca.
8848 BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
8849 TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
8850 bool CannotRemove = false;
8851 for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
8852 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI)) {
8853 CannotRemove = true;
8854 break;
8855 }
Chris Lattneraa0bf522008-06-25 05:59:28 +00008856 if (CallInst *BCI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(BI)) {
8857 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BCI)) {
8858 // If there is a stackrestore below this one, remove this one.
8859 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stackrestore)
8860 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
8861 // Otherwise, ignore the intrinsic.
8862 } else {
8863 // If we found a non-intrinsic call, we can't remove the stack
8864 // restore.
Chris Lattnerbf1d8a72008-02-18 06:12:38 +00008865 CannotRemove = true;
8866 break;
8867 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008868 }
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00008869 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00008870
8871 // If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
8872 // allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
8873 if (!CannotRemove && (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)))
8874 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
8875 break;
8876 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00008877 }
8878
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00008879 return visitCallSite(II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008880}
8881
8882// InvokeInst simplification
8883//
8884Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00008885 return visitCallSite(&II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008886}
8887
Dale Johannesenda30ccb2008-04-25 21:16:07 +00008888/// isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast - If this cast does not affect the value
8889/// passed through the varargs area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00008890static bool isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(const CallSite CS,
8891 const CastInst * const CI,
8892 const TargetData * const TD,
8893 const int ix) {
8894 if (!CI->isLosslessCast())
8895 return false;
8896
8897 // The size of ByVal arguments is derived from the type, so we
8898 // can't change to a type with a different size. If the size were
8899 // passed explicitly we could avoid this check.
8900 if (!CS.paramHasAttr(ix, ParamAttr::ByVal))
8901 return true;
8902
8903 const Type* SrcTy =
8904 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
8905 const Type* DstTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
8906 if (!SrcTy->isSized() || !DstTy->isSized())
8907 return false;
8908 if (TD->getABITypeSize(SrcTy) != TD->getABITypeSize(DstTy))
8909 return false;
8910 return true;
8911}
8912
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00008913// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
8914//
8915Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008916 bool Changed = false;
8917
8918 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
8919 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00008920 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
8921
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008922 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008923
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00008924 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
8925 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
8926 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
8927 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
8928 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008929 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00008930 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
8931 OldCall);
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00008932 if (!OldCall->use_empty())
8933 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(OldCall->getType()));
8934 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
8935 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
8936 return 0;
8937 }
8938
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008939 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
8940 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
8941 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
8942 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008943 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00008944 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008945 CS.getInstruction());
8946
8947 if (!CS.getInstruction()->use_empty())
8948 CS.getInstruction()->
8949 replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
8950
8951 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
8952 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008953 BranchInst::Create(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
8954 ConstantInt::getTrue(), II);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008955 }
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008956 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
8957 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008958
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00008959 if (BitCastInst *BC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Callee))
8960 if (IntrinsicInst *In = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BC->getOperand(0)))
8961 if (In->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::init_trampoline)
8962 return transformCallThroughTrampoline(CS);
8963
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008964 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
8965 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
8966 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
Dale Johannesen63e7eb42008-04-23 01:03:05 +00008967 int ix = FTy->getNumParams() + (isa<InvokeInst>(Callee) ? 3 : 1);
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008968 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
8969 // the call.
8970 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00008971 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I, ++ix) {
8972 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I);
8973 if (CI && isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(CS, CI, TD, ix)) {
8974 *I = CI->getOperand(0);
8975 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008976 }
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00008977 }
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008978 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008979
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +00008980 if (isa<InlineAsm>(Callee) && !CS.doesNotThrow()) {
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +00008981 // Inline asm calls cannot throw - mark them 'nounwind'.
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +00008982 CS.setDoesNotThrow();
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +00008983 Changed = true;
8984 }
8985
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00008986 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00008987}
8988
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008989// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
8990// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
8991//
8992bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
8993 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
8994 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008995 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
8996 !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008997 return false;
Reid Spencer8863f182004-07-18 00:38:32 +00008998 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008999 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009000 const PAListPtr &CallerPAL = CS.getParamAttrs();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009001
9002 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
9003 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
9004 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
9005 //
9006 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
9007 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009008 const Type *NewRetTy = FT->getReturnType();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009009
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009010 if (isa<StructType>(NewRetTy))
Devang Patel75e6f022008-03-11 18:04:06 +00009011 return false; // TODO: Handle multiple return values.
9012
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009013 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009014 if (OldRetTy != NewRetTy) {
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +00009015 if (Callee->isDeclaration() &&
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009016 // Conversion is ok if changing from one pointer type to another or from
9017 // a pointer to an integer of the same size.
9018 !((isa<PointerType>(OldRetTy) || OldRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
Duncan Sands34b176a2008-06-17 15:55:30 +00009019 (isa<PointerType>(NewRetTy) || NewRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType())))
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00009020 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009021
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009022 if (!Caller->use_empty() &&
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009023 // void -> non-void is handled specially
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009024 NewRetTy != Type::VoidTy && !CastInst::isCastable(NewRetTy, OldRetTy))
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009025 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
9026
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009027 if (!CallerPAL.isEmpty() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
9028 ParameterAttributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttrs(0);
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009029 if (RAttrs & ParamAttr::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy))
Duncan Sands6c3470e2008-01-07 17:16:06 +00009030 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
9031 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009032
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009033 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
9034 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
9035 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
9036 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
9037 if (!Caller->use_empty())
9038 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
9039 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
9040 UI != E; ++UI)
9041 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
9042 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +00009043 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009044 return false;
9045 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009046
9047 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
9048 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009049
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009050 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
9051 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
9052 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00009053 const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009054
9055 if (!CastInst::isCastable(ActTy, ParamTy))
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009056 return false; // Cannot transform this parameter value.
9057
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009058 if (CallerPAL.getParamAttrs(i + 1) & ParamAttr::typeIncompatible(ParamTy))
9059 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009060
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009061 // Converting from one pointer type to another or between a pointer and an
9062 // integer of the same size is safe even if we do not have a body.
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00009063 bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009064 ((isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) || ParamTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
9065 (isa<PointerType>(ActTy) || ActTy == TD->getIntPtrType()));
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00009066 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009067 }
9068
9069 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00009070 Callee->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009071 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009072
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009073 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && FT->isVarArg() &&
9074 !CallerPAL.isEmpty())
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009075 // In this case we have more arguments than the new function type, but we
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009076 // won't be dropping them. Check that these extra arguments have attributes
9077 // that are compatible with being a vararg call argument.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009078 for (unsigned i = CallerPAL.getNumSlots(); i; --i) {
9079 if (CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Index <= FT->getNumParams())
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009080 break;
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009081 ParameterAttributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Attrs;
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009082 if (PAttrs & ParamAttr::VarArgsIncompatible)
9083 return false;
9084 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009085
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009086 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
9087 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
9088 std::vector<Value*> Args;
9089 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009090 SmallVector<ParamAttrsWithIndex, 8> attrVec;
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009091 attrVec.reserve(NumCommonArgs);
9092
9093 // Get any return attributes.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009094 ParameterAttributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttrs(0);
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009095
9096 // If the return value is not being used, the type may not be compatible
9097 // with the existing attributes. Wipe out any problematic attributes.
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009098 RAttrs &= ~ParamAttr::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy);
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009099
9100 // Add the new return attributes.
9101 if (RAttrs)
9102 attrVec.push_back(ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(0, RAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009103
9104 AI = CS.arg_begin();
9105 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
9106 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
9107 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
9108 Args.push_back(*AI);
9109 } else {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00009110 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009111 false, ParamTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009112 CastInst *NewCast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009113 Args.push_back(InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *Caller));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009114 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009115
9116 // Add any parameter attributes.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009117 if (ParameterAttributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttrs(i + 1))
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009118 attrVec.push_back(ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009119 }
9120
9121 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
9122 // now...
9123 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
9124 Args.push_back(Constant::getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
9125
9126 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning...
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009127 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009128 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
Bill Wendlinge8156192006-12-07 01:30:32 +00009129 cerr << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
9130 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009131 } else {
9132 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list...
9133 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
9134 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
9135 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
9136 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009137 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false,
9138 PTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009139 Instruction *Cast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009140 InsertNewInstBefore(Cast, *Caller);
9141 Args.push_back(Cast);
9142 } else {
9143 Args.push_back(*AI);
9144 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009145
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009146 // Add any parameter attributes.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009147 if (ParameterAttributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttrs(i + 1))
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009148 attrVec.push_back(ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
9149 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009150 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009151 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009152
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009153 if (NewRetTy == Type::VoidTy)
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009154 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009155
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009156 const PAListPtr &NewCallerPAL = PAListPtr::get(attrVec.begin(),attrVec.end());
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009157
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009158 Instruction *NC;
9159 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009160 NC = InvokeInst::Create(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009161 Args.begin(), Args.end(),
9162 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Reid Spencered3fa852007-07-30 19:53:57 +00009163 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009164 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setParamAttrs(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009165 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009166 NC = CallInst::Create(Callee, Args.begin(), Args.end(),
9167 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009168 CallInst *CI = cast<CallInst>(Caller);
9169 if (CI->isTailCall())
Chris Lattnera9e92112005-05-06 06:48:21 +00009170 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009171 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(CI->getCallingConv());
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009172 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setParamAttrs(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009173 }
9174
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009175 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009176 Value *NV = NC;
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009177 if (OldRetTy != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009178 if (NV->getType() != Type::VoidTy) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009179 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009180 OldRetTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009181 NV = NC = CastInst::Create(opcode, NC, OldRetTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00009182
9183 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
9184 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
9185 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +00009186 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00009187 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
9188 } else {
9189 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
9190 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
9191 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009192 AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009193 } else {
Chris Lattnerc30bda72004-10-17 21:22:38 +00009194 NV = UndefValue::get(Caller->getType());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009195 }
9196 }
9197
9198 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
9199 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00009200 Caller->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009201 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009202 return true;
9203}
9204
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009205// transformCallThroughTrampoline - Turn a call to a function created by the
9206// init_trampoline intrinsic into a direct call to the underlying function.
9207//
9208Instruction *InstCombiner::transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS) {
9209 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
9210 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
9211 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009212 const PAListPtr &Attrs = CS.getParamAttrs();
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009213
9214 // If the call already has the 'nest' attribute somewhere then give up -
9215 // otherwise 'nest' would occur twice after splicing in the chain.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009216 if (Attrs.hasAttrSomewhere(ParamAttr::Nest))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009217 return 0;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009218
9219 IntrinsicInst *Tramp =
9220 cast<IntrinsicInst>(cast<BitCastInst>(Callee)->getOperand(0));
9221
Anton Korobeynikov0b12ecf2008-05-07 22:54:15 +00009222 Function *NestF = cast<Function>(Tramp->getOperand(2)->stripPointerCasts());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009223 const PointerType *NestFPTy = cast<PointerType>(NestF->getType());
9224 const FunctionType *NestFTy = cast<FunctionType>(NestFPTy->getElementType());
9225
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009226 const PAListPtr &NestAttrs = NestF->getParamAttrs();
9227 if (!NestAttrs.isEmpty()) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009228 unsigned NestIdx = 1;
9229 const Type *NestTy = 0;
Dale Johannesen0d51e7e2008-02-19 21:38:47 +00009230 ParameterAttributes NestAttr = ParamAttr::None;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009231
9232 // Look for a parameter marked with the 'nest' attribute.
9233 for (FunctionType::param_iterator I = NestFTy->param_begin(),
9234 E = NestFTy->param_end(); I != E; ++NestIdx, ++I)
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009235 if (NestAttrs.paramHasAttr(NestIdx, ParamAttr::Nest)) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009236 // Record the parameter type and any other attributes.
9237 NestTy = *I;
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009238 NestAttr = NestAttrs.getParamAttrs(NestIdx);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009239 break;
9240 }
9241
9242 if (NestTy) {
9243 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
9244 std::vector<Value*> NewArgs;
9245 NewArgs.reserve(unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin())+1);
9246
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009247 SmallVector<ParamAttrsWithIndex, 8> NewAttrs;
9248 NewAttrs.reserve(Attrs.getNumSlots() + 1);
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009249
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009250 // Insert the nest argument into the call argument list, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009251 // mean appending it. Likewise for attributes.
9252
9253 // Add any function result attributes.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009254 if (ParameterAttributes Attr = Attrs.getParamAttrs(0))
9255 NewAttrs.push_back(ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(0, Attr));
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009256
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009257 {
9258 unsigned Idx = 1;
9259 CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin(), E = CS.arg_end();
9260 do {
9261 if (Idx == NestIdx) {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009262 // Add the chain argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009263 Value *NestVal = Tramp->getOperand(3);
9264 if (NestVal->getType() != NestTy)
9265 NestVal = new BitCastInst(NestVal, NestTy, "nest", Caller);
9266 NewArgs.push_back(NestVal);
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009267 NewAttrs.push_back(ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(NestIdx, NestAttr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009268 }
9269
9270 if (I == E)
9271 break;
9272
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009273 // Add the original argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009274 NewArgs.push_back(*I);
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009275 if (ParameterAttributes Attr = Attrs.getParamAttrs(Idx))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009276 NewAttrs.push_back
9277 (ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(Idx + (Idx >= NestIdx), Attr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009278
9279 ++Idx, ++I;
9280 } while (1);
9281 }
9282
9283 // The trampoline may have been bitcast to a bogus type (FTy).
9284 // Handle this by synthesizing a new function type, equal to FTy
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009285 // with the chain parameter inserted.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009286
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009287 std::vector<const Type*> NewTypes;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009288 NewTypes.reserve(FTy->getNumParams()+1);
9289
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009290 // Insert the chain's type into the list of parameter types, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009291 // mean appending it.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009292 {
9293 unsigned Idx = 1;
9294 FunctionType::param_iterator I = FTy->param_begin(),
9295 E = FTy->param_end();
9296
9297 do {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009298 if (Idx == NestIdx)
9299 // Add the chain's type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009300 NewTypes.push_back(NestTy);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009301
9302 if (I == E)
9303 break;
9304
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009305 // Add the original type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009306 NewTypes.push_back(*I);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009307
9308 ++Idx, ++I;
9309 } while (1);
9310 }
9311
9312 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Let the generic
9313 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
9314 FunctionType *NewFTy =
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009315 FunctionType::get(FTy->getReturnType(), NewTypes, FTy->isVarArg());
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009316 Constant *NewCallee = NestF->getType() == PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy) ?
9317 NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy));
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009318 const PAListPtr &NewPAL = PAListPtr::get(NewAttrs.begin(),NewAttrs.end());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009319
9320 Instruction *NewCaller;
9321 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009322 NewCaller = InvokeInst::Create(NewCallee,
9323 II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
9324 NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
9325 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009326 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009327 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setParamAttrs(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009328 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009329 NewCaller = CallInst::Create(NewCallee, NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
9330 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009331 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
9332 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setTailCall();
9333 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->
9334 setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009335 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setParamAttrs(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009336 }
9337 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
9338 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NewCaller);
9339 Caller->eraseFromParent();
9340 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
9341 return 0;
9342 }
9343 }
9344
9345 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Since there is no 'nest'
9346 // parameter, there is no need to adjust the argument list. Let the generic
9347 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
9348 Constant *NewCallee =
9349 NestF->getType() == PTy ? NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PTy);
9350 CS.setCalledFunction(NewCallee);
9351 return CS.getInstruction();
9352}
9353
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009354/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(c,d)]
9355/// and if a/b/c/d and the add's all have a single use, turn this into two phi's
9356/// and a single binop.
9357Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
9358 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00009359 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) ||
9360 isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009361 unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009362 Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
9363 Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
9364
9365 const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
9366 const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009367
9368 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, all have one use, and all
9369 // kill their operands (i.e. the operands have one use).
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00009370 for (unsigned i = 0; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009371 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00009372 if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009373 // Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009374 // types or GEP's with different index types.
9375 I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
9376 I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009377 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009378
9379 // If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
9380 if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
9381 if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
9382 cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
9383 return 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009384
9385 // Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
9386 if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
9387 if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009388 }
9389
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009390 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform, determine if it is profitable.
9391
9392 // If this is a GEP, and if the index (not the pointer) needs a PHI, bail out.
9393 // Indexes are often folded into load/store instructions, so we don't want to
9394 // hide them behind a phi.
9395 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) && RHSVal == 0)
9396 return 0;
9397
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009398 Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009399 Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009400 PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009401 if (LHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009402 NewLHS = PHINode::Create(LHSType,
9403 FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009404 NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
9405 NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009406 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
9407 LHSVal = NewLHS;
9408 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009409
9410 if (RHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009411 NewRHS = PHINode::Create(RHSType,
9412 FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009413 NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
9414 NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009415 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
9416 RHSVal = NewRHS;
9417 }
9418
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009419 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
9420 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9421 if (NewLHS) {
9422 Value *NewInLHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
9423 NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9424 }
9425 if (NewRHS) {
9426 Value *NewInRHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(1);
9427 NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9428 }
9429 }
9430
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009431 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009432 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009433 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009434 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(), LHSVal,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009435 RHSVal);
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009436 else {
9437 assert(isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst));
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009438 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(LHSVal, RHSVal);
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009439 }
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009440}
9441
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009442/// isSafeToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe sink the load out
9443/// of the block that defines it. This means that it must be obvious the value
9444/// of the load is not changed from the point of the load to the end of the
9445/// block it is in.
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00009446///
9447/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
9448/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
9449/// to a register.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009450static bool isSafeToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
9451 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
9452
9453 for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
9454 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
9455 return false;
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00009456
9457 // Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
9458 // profitable to do this xform.
9459 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
9460 bool isAddressTaken = false;
9461 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
9462 UI != E; ++UI) {
9463 if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
9464 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
9465 // If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
9466 if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
9467 }
9468 isAddressTaken = true;
9469 break;
9470 }
9471
9472 if (!isAddressTaken)
9473 return false;
9474 }
9475
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009476 return true;
9477}
9478
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009479
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009480// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
9481// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
9482// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
9483Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
9484 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
9485
9486 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
9487 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
9488 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
9489 // code size and simplifying code.
9490 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
9491 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009492 bool isVolatile = false;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009493 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
9494 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00009495 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009496 // Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
9497 // otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009498 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009499 if (ConstantOp == 0)
9500 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009501 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(FirstInst)) {
9502 isVolatile = LI->isVolatile();
9503 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
9504 // load and the PHI.
9505 if (LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
9506 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
9507 return 0;
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +00009508
9509 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
9510 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
9511 // the path through the other successor.
9512 if (isVolatile &&
9513 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
9514 return 0;
9515
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009516 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst)) {
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009517 if (FirstInst->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009518 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
9519 // Can't handle general GEPs yet.
9520 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009521 } else {
9522 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
9523 }
9524
9525 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
9526 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9527 if (!isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) return 0;
9528 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009529 if (!I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009530 return 0;
9531 if (CastSrcTy) {
9532 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
9533 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009534 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009535 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
9536 // the load and the PHI.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00009537 if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
9538 LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
9539 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
9540 return 0;
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +00009541
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +00009542 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
9543 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
9544 // the path through the other successor.
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +00009545 if (isVolatile &&
9546 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
9547 return 0;
9548
9549
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009550 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
9551 return 0;
9552 }
9553 }
9554
9555 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
9556 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009557 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
9558 PN.getName()+".in");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00009559 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00009560
9561 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
9562 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009563
9564 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00009565 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9566 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
9567 if (NewInVal != InVal)
9568 InVal = 0;
9569 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
9570 }
9571
9572 Value *PhiVal;
9573 if (InVal) {
9574 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
9575 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
9576 PhiVal = InVal;
9577 delete NewPN;
9578 } else {
9579 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
9580 PhiVal = NewPN;
9581 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009582
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009583 // Insert and return the new operation.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009584 if (CastInst* FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009585 return CastInst::Create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +00009586 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009587 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +00009588 if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009589 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009590 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +00009591 assert(isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst) && "Unknown operation");
9592
9593 // If this was a volatile load that we are merging, make sure to loop through
9594 // and mark all the input loads as non-volatile. If we don't do this, we will
9595 // insert a new volatile load and the old ones will not be deletable.
9596 if (isVolatile)
9597 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
9598 cast<LoadInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->setVolatile(false);
9599
9600 return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00009601}
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00009602
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009603/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
9604/// that is dead.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00009605static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN,
9606 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009607 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
9608 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
9609
9610 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00009611 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN))
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009612 return true;
Chris Lattner92103de2007-08-28 04:23:55 +00009613
9614 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
9615 if (PotentiallyDeadPHIs.size() == 16)
9616 return false;
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009617
9618 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
9619 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009620
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00009621 return false;
9622}
9623
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +00009624/// PHIsEqualValue - Return true if this phi node is always equal to
9625/// NonPhiInVal. This happens with mutually cyclic phi nodes like:
9626/// z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
9627static bool PHIsEqualValue(PHINode *PN, Value *NonPhiInVal,
9628 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &ValueEqualPHIs) {
9629 // See if we already saw this PHI node.
9630 if (!ValueEqualPHIs.insert(PN))
9631 return true;
9632
9633 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
9634 if (ValueEqualPHIs.size() == 16)
9635 return false;
9636
9637 // Scan the operands to see if they are either phi nodes or are equal to
9638 // the value.
9639 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
9640 Value *Op = PN->getIncomingValue(i);
9641 if (PHINode *OpPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(Op)) {
9642 if (!PHIsEqualValue(OpPN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
9643 return false;
9644 } else if (Op != NonPhiInVal)
9645 return false;
9646 }
9647
9648 return true;
9649}
9650
9651
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +00009652// PHINode simplification
9653//
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00009654Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
Owen Andersonb64ab872006-07-10 22:15:25 +00009655 // If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +00009656 if (MustPreserveLCSSA) return 0;
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +00009657
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00009658 if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
9659 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
9660
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00009661 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
9662 // reducing code size.
9663 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
9664 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
9665 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
9666 return Result;
9667
9668 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
9669 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
9670 // PHI)... break the cycle.
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00009671 if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
9672 Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
9673 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00009674 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00009675 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
9676 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
9677 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
9678 }
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00009679
9680 // If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
9681 // the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
9682 // induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
9683 // common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
9684 // are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
9685 // late.
9686 if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
9687 (isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
9688 PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
9689 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
9690 }
9691 }
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00009692
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +00009693 // We sometimes end up with phi cycles that non-obviously end up being the
9694 // same value, for example:
9695 // z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
9696 // where the phi nodes don't necessarily need to be in the same block. Do a
9697 // quick check to see if the PHI node only contains a single non-phi value, if
9698 // so, scan to see if the phi cycle is actually equal to that value.
9699 {
9700 unsigned InValNo = 0, NumOperandVals = PN.getNumIncomingValues();
9701 // Scan for the first non-phi operand.
9702 while (InValNo != NumOperandVals &&
9703 isa<PHINode>(PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo)))
9704 ++InValNo;
9705
9706 if (InValNo != NumOperandVals) {
9707 Value *NonPhiInVal = PN.getOperand(InValNo);
9708
9709 // Scan the rest of the operands to see if there are any conflicts, if so
9710 // there is no need to recursively scan other phis.
9711 for (++InValNo; InValNo != NumOperandVals; ++InValNo) {
9712 Value *OpVal = PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo);
9713 if (OpVal != NonPhiInVal && !isa<PHINode>(OpVal))
9714 break;
9715 }
9716
9717 // If we scanned over all operands, then we have one unique value plus
9718 // phi values. Scan PHI nodes to see if they all merge in each other or
9719 // the value.
9720 if (InValNo == NumOperandVals) {
9721 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> ValueEqualPHIs;
9722 if (PHIsEqualValue(&PN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
9723 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, NonPhiInVal);
9724 }
9725 }
9726 }
Chris Lattner60921c92003-12-19 05:58:40 +00009727 return 0;
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +00009728}
9729
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009730static Value *InsertCastToIntPtrTy(Value *V, const Type *DTy,
9731 Instruction *InsertPoint,
9732 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00009733 unsigned PtrSize = DTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
9734 unsigned VTySize = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009735 // We must cast correctly to the pointer type. Ensure that we
9736 // sign extend the integer value if it is smaller as this is
9737 // used for address computation.
9738 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
9739 (VTySize < PtrSize ? Instruction::SExt :
9740 (VTySize == PtrSize ? Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc));
9741 return IC->InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DTy, *InsertPoint);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009742}
9743
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00009744
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00009745Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009746 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00009747 // Is it 'getelementptr %P, i32 0' or 'getelementptr %P'
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00009748 // If so, eliminate the noop.
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00009749 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 1)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009750 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00009751
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009752 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
9753 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, UndefValue::get(GEP.getType()));
9754
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00009755 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
9756 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
9757 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isNullValue();
9758
9759 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 && HasZeroPointerIndex)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009760 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00009761
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009762 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
9763 bool MadeChange = false;
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00009764
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00009765 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009766 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP.op_begin() + 1, e = GEP.op_end();
9767 i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00009768 if (isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009769 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*i)) {
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00009770 if (CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::ZExt ||
9771 CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt) {
9772 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType();
9773 // We can eliminate a cast from i32 to i64 iff the target
9774 // is a 32-bit pointer target.
9775 if (SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
9776 MadeChange = true;
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009777 *i = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009778 }
9779 }
9780 }
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00009781 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
9782 // to what we need. If the incoming value needs a cast instruction,
9783 // insert it. This explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more
9784 // obvious.
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009785 Value *Op = *i;
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009786 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) > TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00009787 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009788 *i = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(C, TD->getIntPtrType());
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00009789 MadeChange = true;
9790 } else {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009791 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
9792 GEP);
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009793 *i = Op;
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00009794 MadeChange = true;
9795 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009796 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009797 }
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00009798 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009799 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
9800
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00009801 // If this GEP instruction doesn't move the pointer, and if the input operand
9802 // is a bitcast of another pointer, just replace the GEP with a bitcast of the
9803 // real input to the dest type.
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00009804 if (GEP.hasAllZeroIndices()) {
9805 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(GEP.getOperand(0))) {
9806 // If the bitcast is of an allocation, and the allocation will be
9807 // converted to match the type of the cast, don't touch this.
9808 if (isa<AllocationInst>(BCI->getOperand(0))) {
9809 // See if the bitcast simplifies, if so, don't nuke this GEP yet.
Chris Lattnera79dd432007-10-12 18:05:47 +00009810 if (Instruction *I = visitBitCast(*BCI)) {
9811 if (I != BCI) {
9812 I->takeName(BCI);
9813 BCI->getParent()->getInstList().insert(BCI, I);
9814 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*BCI, I);
9815 }
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00009816 return &GEP;
Chris Lattnera79dd432007-10-12 18:05:47 +00009817 }
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00009818 }
9819 return new BitCastInst(BCI->getOperand(0), GEP.getType());
9820 }
9821 }
9822
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009823 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
9824 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
9825 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
9826 //
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00009827 SmallVector<Value*, 8> SrcGEPOperands;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00009828 if (User *Src = dyn_castGetElementPtr(PtrOp))
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00009829 SrcGEPOperands.append(Src->op_begin(), Src->op_end());
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +00009830
9831 if (!SrcGEPOperands.empty()) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009832 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
9833 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
9834 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
9835 //
9836 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(SrcGEPOperands[0]) &&
9837 cast<Instruction>(SrcGEPOperands[0])->getNumOperands() == 2)
9838 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
9839
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00009840 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009841
9842 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
9843 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
9844 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*cast<User>(PtrOp)),
9845 E = gep_type_end(*cast<User>(PtrOp)); I != E; ++I)
Chris Lattnerbe97b4e2004-05-08 22:41:42 +00009846 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009847
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009848 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009849 if (EndsWithSequential) {
Chris Lattnerdecd0812003-03-05 22:33:14 +00009850 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
9851 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
9852 //
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009853 Value *Sum, *SO1 = SrcGEPOperands.back(), *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009854 if (SO1 == Constant::getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
9855 Sum = GO1;
9856 } else if (GO1 == Constant::getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
9857 Sum = SO1;
9858 } else {
9859 // If they aren't the same type, convert both to an integer of the
9860 // target's pointer size.
9861 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType()) {
9862 if (Constant *SO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009863 SO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(SO1C, GO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009864 } else if (Constant *GO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009865 GO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(GO1C, SO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009866 } else {
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00009867 unsigned PS = TD->getPointerSizeInBits();
9868 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(SO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009869 // Convert GO1 to SO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009870 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, SO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009871
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00009872 } else if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(GO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009873 // Convert SO1 to GO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009874 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, GO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009875 } else {
9876 const Type *PT = TD->getIntPtrType();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009877 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, PT, &GEP, this);
9878 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, PT, &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009879 }
9880 }
9881 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009882 if (isa<Constant>(SO1) && isa<Constant>(GO1))
9883 Sum = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(SO1), cast<Constant>(GO1));
9884 else {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009885 Sum = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00009886 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Sum), GEP);
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009887 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009888 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009889
9890 // Recycle the GEP we already have if possible.
9891 if (SrcGEPOperands.size() == 2) {
9892 GEP.setOperand(0, SrcGEPOperands[0]);
9893 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
9894 return &GEP;
9895 } else {
9896 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
9897 SrcGEPOperands.end()-1);
9898 Indices.push_back(Sum);
9899 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
9900 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009901 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00009902 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009903 SrcGEPOperands.size() != 1) {
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009904 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +00009905 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
9906 SrcGEPOperands.end());
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00009907 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
9908 }
9909
9910 if (!Indices.empty())
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009911 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(SrcGEPOperands[0], Indices.begin(),
9912 Indices.end(), GEP.getName());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00009913
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00009914 } else if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00009915 // GEP of global variable. If all of the indices for this GEP are
9916 // constants, we can promote this to a constexpr instead of an instruction.
9917
9918 // Scan for nonconstants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00009919 SmallVector<Constant*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00009920 User::op_iterator I = GEP.idx_begin(), E = GEP.idx_end();
9921 for (; I != E && isa<Constant>(*I); ++I)
9922 Indices.push_back(cast<Constant>(*I));
9923
9924 if (I == E) { // If they are all constants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00009925 Constant *CE = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(GV,
9926 &Indices[0],Indices.size());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00009927
9928 // Replace all uses of the GEP with the new constexpr...
9929 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, CE);
9930 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009931 } else if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) { // Is the operand a cast?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00009932 if (!isa<PointerType>(X->getType())) {
9933 // Not interesting. Source pointer must be a cast from pointer.
9934 } else if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009935 // transform: GEP (bitcast [10 x i8]* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ...
9936 // into : GEP [10 x i8]* X, i32 0, ...
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00009937 //
9938 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
9939 //
9940 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
9941 const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
9942 if (const ArrayType *XATy =
9943 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType()))
9944 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
9945 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType()))
9946 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
9947 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
9948 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
9949 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
9950 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
9951 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
9952 return &GEP;
9953 }
9954 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
9955 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009956 // %t = getelementptr i32* bitcast ([2 x i32]* %str to i32*), i32 %V
9957 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x i32]* %str, i32 0, i32 %V; bitcast
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00009958 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
9959 const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
9960 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00009961 TD->getABITypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
9962 TD->getABITypeSize(ResElTy)) {
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00009963 Value *Idx[2];
9964 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
9965 Idx[1] = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00009966 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009967 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName()), GEP);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009968 // V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
9969 return new BitCastInst(V, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00009970 }
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009971
9972 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009973 // getelementptr i8* bitcast ([100 x double]* X to i8*), i32 %tmp
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009974 // (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009975 // getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, i32 0, i32 %tmp2; bitcast
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009976
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +00009977 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) && ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty) {
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009978 uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +00009979 TD->getABITypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009980
9981 // Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
9982 // allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
9983 Value *NewIdx = 0;
9984 ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
9985 if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
9986 NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
9987 Scale = ConstantInt::get(NewIdx->getType(), 1);
9988 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6e2f8432005-09-14 17:32:56 +00009989 NewIdx = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009990 Scale = CI;
9991 } else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
9992 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
9993 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00009994 ConstantInt *ShAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
9995 uint32_t ShAmtVal = ShAmt->getLimitedValue(64);
9996 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Inst->getType(), 1ULL << ShAmtVal);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00009997 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
9998 } else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
9999 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
10000 Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
10001 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
10002 }
10003 }
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010004
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010005 // If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010006 // out, perform the transformation. Note, we don't know whether Scale is
10007 // signed or not. We'll use unsigned version of division/modulo
10008 // operation after making sure Scale doesn't have the sign bit set.
10009 if (Scale && Scale->getSExtValue() >= 0LL &&
10010 Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
10011 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Scale->getType(),
10012 Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010013 if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010014 Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010015 false /*ZExt*/);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010016 Instruction *Sc = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010017 NewIdx = InsertNewInstBefore(Sc, GEP);
10018 }
10019
10020 // Insert the new GEP instruction.
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000010021 Value *Idx[2];
10022 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10023 Idx[1] = NewIdx;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010024 Instruction *NewGEP =
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010025 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010026 NewGEP = InsertNewInstBefore(NewGEP, GEP);
10027 // The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
10028 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010029 }
10030 }
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010031 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010032 }
10033
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010034 return 0;
10035}
10036
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010037Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI) {
10038 // Convert: malloc Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: malloc [C x Ty], 1
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010039 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) { // Check C != 1
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010040 if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
10041 const Type *NewTy =
10042 ArrayType::get(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000010043 AllocationInst *New = 0;
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010044
10045 // Create and insert the replacement instruction...
10046 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +000010047 New = new MallocInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000010048 else {
10049 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +000010050 New = new AllocaInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000010051 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010052
10053 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010054
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010055 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
10056 // allocas if possible...
10057 //
10058 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
10059 while (isa<AllocationInst>(*It)) ++It;
10060
10061 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
10062 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
10063 //
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010064 Value *NullIdx = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000010065 Value *Idx[2];
10066 Idx[0] = NullIdx;
10067 Idx[1] = NullIdx;
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010068 Value *V = GetElementPtrInst::Create(New, Idx, Idx + 2,
10069 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010070
10071 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
10072 // allocation.
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010073 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010074 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
10075 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010076 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010077 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010078
10079 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
10080 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate and
10081 // return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010082 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized() &&
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010083 TD->getABITypeSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010084 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
10085
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010086 return 0;
10087}
10088
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000010089Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI) {
10090 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(0);
10091
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010092 // free undef -> unreachable.
10093 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
10094 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +000010095 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +000010096 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)), &FI);
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010097 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
10098 }
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000010099
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000010100 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
10101 // when lots of inlining happens.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010102 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000010103 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000010104
10105 // Change free <ty>* (cast <ty2>* X to <ty>*) into free <ty2>* X
10106 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op)) {
10107 FI.setOperand(0, CI->getOperand(0));
10108 return &FI;
10109 }
10110
10111 // Change free (gep X, 0,0,0,0) into free(X)
10112 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
10113 if (GEPI->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
10114 AddToWorkList(GEPI);
10115 FI.setOperand(0, GEPI->getOperand(0));
10116 return &FI;
10117 }
10118 }
10119
10120 // Change free(malloc) into nothing, if the malloc has a single use.
10121 if (MallocInst *MI = dyn_cast<MallocInst>(Op))
10122 if (MI->hasOneUse()) {
10123 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
10124 return EraseInstFromFunction(*MI);
10125 }
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000010126
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000010127 return 0;
10128}
10129
10130
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010131/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010132static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI,
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000010133 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010134 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010135 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010136
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010137 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(CI)) {
10138 // Instead of loading constant c string, use corresponding integer value
10139 // directly if string length is small enough.
Evan Cheng0ff39b32008-06-30 07:31:25 +000010140 std::string Str;
10141 if (GetConstantStringInfo(CE->getOperand(0), Str) && !Str.empty()) {
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010142 unsigned len = Str.length();
10143 const Type *Ty = cast<PointerType>(CE->getType())->getElementType();
10144 unsigned numBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
10145 // Replace LI with immediate integer store.
10146 if ((numBits >> 3) == len + 1) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000010147 APInt StrVal(numBits, 0);
10148 APInt SingleChar(numBits, 0);
10149 if (TD->isLittleEndian()) {
10150 for (signed i = len-1; i >= 0; i--) {
10151 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
10152 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10153 }
10154 } else {
10155 for (unsigned i = 0; i < len; i++) {
10156 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
10157 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10158 }
10159 // Append NULL at the end.
10160 SingleChar = 0;
10161 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10162 }
10163 Value *NL = ConstantInt::get(StrVal);
10164 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, NL);
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010165 }
10166 }
10167 }
10168
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010169 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010170 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010171 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010172
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010173 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010174 isa<VectorType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010175 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
10176 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
10177 // constants.
10178 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
10179 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
10180 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010181 Value *Idxs[2];
10182 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10183 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010184 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
10185 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10186 }
10187
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010188 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010189 isa<VectorType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Chris Lattnerb1515fe2005-03-29 06:37:47 +000010190 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
10191 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
10192 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010193 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
10194 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010195
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010196 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
10197 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
10198 // the result of the loaded value.
10199 Value *NewLoad = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(CastOp,
10200 CI->getName(),
10201 LI.isVolatile()),LI);
10202 // Now cast the result of the load.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010203 return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010204 }
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010205 }
10206 }
10207 return 0;
10208}
10209
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010210/// isSafeToLoadUnconditionally - Return true if we know that executing a load
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010211/// from this value cannot trap. If it is not obviously safe to load from the
10212/// specified pointer, we do a quick local scan of the basic block containing
10213/// ScanFrom, to determine if the address is already accessed.
10214static bool isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(Value *V, Instruction *ScanFrom) {
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010215 // If it is an alloca it is always safe to load from.
10216 if (isa<AllocaInst>(V)) return true;
10217
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +000010218 // If it is a global variable it is mostly safe to load from.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010219 if (const GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(V))
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +000010220 // Don't try to evaluate aliases. External weak GV can be null.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010221 return !isa<GlobalAlias>(GV) && !GV->hasExternalWeakLinkage();
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010222
10223 // Otherwise, be a little bit agressive by scanning the local block where we
10224 // want to check to see if the pointer is already being loaded or stored
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010225 // from/to. If so, the previous load or store would have already trapped,
10226 // so there is no harm doing an extra load (also, CSE will later eliminate
10227 // the load entirely).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010228 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = ScanFrom, E = ScanFrom->getParent()->begin();
10229
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010230 while (BBI != E) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010231 --BBI;
10232
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010233 // If we see a free or a call (which might do a free) the pointer could be
10234 // marked invalid.
10235 if (isa<FreeInst>(BBI) || isa<CallInst>(BBI))
10236 return false;
10237
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010238 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
10239 if (LI->getOperand(0) == V) return true;
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010240 } else if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010241 if (SI->getOperand(1) == V) return true;
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010242 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010243
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010244 }
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010245 return false;
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010246}
10247
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000010248/// GetUnderlyingObject - Trace through a series of getelementptrs and bitcasts
10249/// until we find the underlying object a pointer is referring to or something
10250/// we don't understand. Note that the returned pointer may be offset from the
10251/// input, because we ignore GEP indices.
10252static Value *GetUnderlyingObject(Value *Ptr) {
10253 while (1) {
10254 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr)) {
10255 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast ||
10256 CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
10257 Ptr = CE->getOperand(0);
10258 else
10259 return Ptr;
10260 } else if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Ptr)) {
10261 Ptr = BCI->getOperand(0);
10262 } else if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr)) {
10263 Ptr = GEP->getOperand(0);
10264 } else {
10265 return Ptr;
10266 }
10267 }
10268}
10269
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010270Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
10271 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner5f16a132004-01-12 04:13:56 +000010272
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010273 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010274 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Op);
10275 if (KnownAlign >
10276 (LI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(LI.getType()) :
10277 LI.getAlignment()))
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010278 LI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
10279
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010280 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000010281 if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010282 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010283 return Res;
10284
10285 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
10286 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010287
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010288 if (&LI.getParent()->front() != &LI) {
10289 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI; --BBI;
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +000010290 // If the instruction immediately before this is a store to the same
10291 // address, do a simple form of store->load forwarding.
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010292 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))
10293 if (SI->getOperand(1) == LI.getOperand(0))
10294 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, SI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +000010295 if (LoadInst *LIB = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI))
10296 if (LIB->getOperand(0) == LI.getOperand(0))
10297 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, LIB);
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010298 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010299
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010300 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
10301 const Value *GEPI0 = GEPI->getOperand(0);
10302 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
10303 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI0) &&
10304 cast<PointerType>(GEPI0->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010305 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
10306 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
10307 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
10308 // CFG.
10309 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10310 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
10311 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10312 }
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010313 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010314
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010315 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010316 // load null/undef -> undef
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010317 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
10318 if (isa<UndefValue>(C) || (C->isNullValue() &&
10319 cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0)) {
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010320 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
10321 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
10322 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010323 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10324 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010325 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010326 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010327
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010328 // Instcombine load (constant global) into the value loaded.
10329 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010330 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010331 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, GV->getInitializer());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010332
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010333 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_GEP global, 0, ...) into the value loaded.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010334 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010335 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
10336 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010337 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner363f2a22005-09-26 05:28:06 +000010338 if (Constant *V =
10339 ConstantFoldLoadThroughGEPConstantExpr(GV->getInitializer(), CE))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010340 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, V);
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010341 if (CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) {
10342 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
10343 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
10344 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
10345 // CFG.
10346 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10347 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
10348 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10349 }
10350
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010351 } else if (CE->isCast()) {
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010352 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010353 return Res;
10354 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010355 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010356 }
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000010357
10358 // If this load comes from anywhere in a constant global, and if the global
10359 // is all undef or zero, we know what it loads.
10360 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(GetUnderlyingObject(Op))) {
10361 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasInitializer()) {
10362 if (GV->getInitializer()->isNullValue())
10363 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, Constant::getNullValue(LI.getType()));
10364 else if (isa<UndefValue>(GV->getInitializer()))
10365 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10366 }
10367 }
Chris Lattnerf499eac2004-04-08 20:39:49 +000010368
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010369 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010370 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
10371 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
10372 // exposes redundancy in the code.
10373 //
10374 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
10375 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
10376 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
10377 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
10378 // unconditionally.
10379 //
10380 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
10381 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010382 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
10383 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010384 Value *V1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +000010385 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010386 Value *V2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(2),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +000010387 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010388 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010389 }
10390
Chris Lattner684fe212004-09-23 15:46:00 +000010391 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
10392 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
10393 if (C->isNullValue()) {
10394 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
10395 return &LI;
10396 }
10397
10398 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
10399 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
10400 if (C->isNullValue()) {
10401 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
10402 return &LI;
10403 }
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010404 }
10405 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010406 return 0;
10407}
10408
Reid Spencer55af2b52007-01-19 21:20:31 +000010409/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010410/// when possible.
10411static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
10412 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
10413 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
10414
10415 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
10416 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
10417 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10418
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010419 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010420 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
10421 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
10422 // constants.
10423 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
10424 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
10425 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010426 Value* Idxs[2];
10427 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10428 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010429 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
10430 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10431 }
10432
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +000010433 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy)) &&
10434 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
10435 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010436
10437 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010438 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
10439 // the store, cast the value to be stored.
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010440 Value *NewCast;
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010441 Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010442 Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
10443 const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
10444 const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
10445 if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
10446 if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010447 opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +000010448 } else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +000010449 if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010450 opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
10451 }
10452 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SIOp0))
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010453 NewCast = ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, CastDstTy);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010454 else
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010455 NewCast = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010456 CastInst::Create(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy, SIOp0->getName()+".c"),
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000010457 SI);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010458 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
10459 }
10460 }
10461 }
10462 return 0;
10463}
10464
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010465Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
10466 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
10467 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
10468
10469 if (isa<UndefValue>(Ptr)) { // store X, undef -> noop (even if volatile)
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010470 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010471 ++NumCombined;
10472 return 0;
10473 }
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000010474
10475 // If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
10476 // alloca dead.
Chris Lattnercea1fdd2008-04-29 04:58:38 +000010477 if (Ptr->hasOneUse() && !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000010478 if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
10479 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10480 ++NumCombined;
10481 return 0;
10482 }
10483
10484 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr))
10485 if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) &&
10486 GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
10487 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10488 ++NumCombined;
10489 return 0;
10490 }
10491 }
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010492
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010493 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010494 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Ptr);
10495 if (KnownAlign >
10496 (SI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(Val->getType()) :
10497 SI.getAlignment()))
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010498 SI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
10499
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010500 // Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consequtive
10501 // stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
10502 // situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
10503 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
10504 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
10505 --ScanInsts) {
10506 --BBI;
10507
10508 if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
10509 // Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
10510 if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() && PrevSI->getOperand(1) == SI.getOperand(1)) {
10511 ++NumDeadStore;
10512 ++BBI;
10513 EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
10514 continue;
10515 }
10516 break;
10517 }
10518
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000010519 // If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
10520 // the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
10521 // then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
10522 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
Chris Lattnera54c7eb2007-09-07 05:33:03 +000010523 if (LI == Val && LI->getOperand(0) == Ptr && !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000010524 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10525 ++NumCombined;
10526 return 0;
10527 }
10528 // Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
10529 // may not be dead.
10530 break;
10531 }
10532
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010533 // Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
Chris Lattner0ef546e2008-05-08 17:20:30 +000010534 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory() || BBI->mayReadFromMemory())
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010535 break;
10536 }
10537
10538
10539 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010540
10541 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
10542 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr)) {
10543 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
10544 SI.setOperand(0, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
10545 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010546 AddToWorkList(U); // Dropped a use.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010547 ++NumCombined;
10548 }
10549 return 0; // Do not modify these!
10550 }
10551
10552 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
10553 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010554 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010555 ++NumCombined;
10556 return 0;
10557 }
10558
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010559 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
10560 // source instead.
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000010561 if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010562 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
10563 return Res;
10564 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010565 if (CE->isCast())
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010566 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
10567 return Res;
10568
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000010569
10570 // If this store is the last instruction in the basic block, and if the block
10571 // ends with an unconditional branch, try to move it to the successor block.
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000010572 BBI = &SI; ++BBI;
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000010573 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010574 if (BI->isUnconditional())
10575 if (SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(SI))
10576 return 0; // xform done!
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000010577
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010578 return 0;
10579}
10580
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010581/// SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock - Turn things like:
10582/// if () { *P = v1; } else { *P = v2 }
10583/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
10584///
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010585/// Simplify things like:
10586/// *P = v1; if () { *P = v2; }
10587/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
10588///
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010589bool InstCombiner::SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI) {
10590 BasicBlock *StoreBB = SI.getParent();
10591
10592 // Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
10593 // so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
10594 // if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010595 BasicBlock *DestBB = StoreBB->getTerminator()->getSuccessor(0);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010596
10597 // Determine whether Dest has exactly two predecessors and, if so, compute
10598 // the other predecessor.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010599 pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(DestBB);
10600 BasicBlock *OtherBB = 0;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010601 if (*PI != StoreBB)
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010602 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010603 ++PI;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010604 if (PI == pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010605 return false;
10606
10607 if (*PI != StoreBB) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010608 if (OtherBB)
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010609 return false;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010610 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010611 }
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010612 if (++PI != pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010613 return false;
Eli Friedman66fe80a2008-06-13 21:17:49 +000010614
10615 // Bail out if all the relevant blocks aren't distinct (this can happen,
10616 // for example, if SI is in an infinite loop)
10617 if (StoreBB == DestBB || OtherBB == DestBB)
10618 return false;
10619
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010620 // Verify that the other block ends in a branch and is not otherwise empty.
10621 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = OtherBB->getTerminator();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010622 BranchInst *OtherBr = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI);
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010623 if (!OtherBr || BBI == OtherBB->begin())
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010624 return false;
10625
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010626 // If the other block ends in an unconditional branch, check for the 'if then
10627 // else' case. there is an instruction before the branch.
10628 StoreInst *OtherStore = 0;
10629 if (OtherBr->isUnconditional()) {
10630 // If this isn't a store, or isn't a store to the same location, bail out.
10631 --BBI;
10632 OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
10633 if (!OtherStore || OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
10634 return false;
10635 } else {
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000010636 // Otherwise, the other block ended with a conditional branch. If one of the
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010637 // destinations is StoreBB, then we have the if/then case.
10638 if (OtherBr->getSuccessor(0) != StoreBB &&
10639 OtherBr->getSuccessor(1) != StoreBB)
10640 return false;
10641
10642 // Okay, we know that OtherBr now goes to Dest and StoreBB, so this is an
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000010643 // if/then triangle. See if there is a store to the same ptr as SI that
10644 // lives in OtherBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010645 for (;; --BBI) {
10646 // Check to see if we find the matching store.
10647 if ((OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))) {
10648 if (OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
10649 return false;
10650 break;
10651 }
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000010652 // If we find something that may be using or overwriting the stored
10653 // value, or if we run out of instructions, we can't do the xform.
10654 if (BBI->mayReadFromMemory() || BBI->mayWriteToMemory() ||
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010655 BBI == OtherBB->begin())
10656 return false;
10657 }
10658
10659 // In order to eliminate the store in OtherBr, we have to
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000010660 // make sure nothing reads or overwrites the stored value in
10661 // StoreBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010662 for (BasicBlock::iterator I = StoreBB->begin(); &*I != &SI; ++I) {
10663 // FIXME: This should really be AA driven.
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000010664 if (I->mayReadFromMemory() || I->mayWriteToMemory())
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010665 return false;
10666 }
10667 }
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010668
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010669 // Insert a PHI node now if we need it.
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010670 Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
10671 if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010672 PHINode *PN = PHINode::Create(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010673 PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
10674 PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000010675 PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), OtherBB);
10676 MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, DestBB->front());
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010677 }
10678
10679 // Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
10680 // insert it.
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000010681 BBI = DestBB->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000010682 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
10683 OtherStore->isVolatile()), *BBI);
10684
10685 // Nuke the old stores.
10686 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
10687 EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
10688 ++NumCombined;
10689 return true;
10690}
10691
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010692
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000010693Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
10694 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +000010695 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000010696 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
10697 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
10698 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
10699 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
10700 // Swap Destinations and condition...
10701 BI.setCondition(X);
10702 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
10703 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
10704 return &BI;
10705 }
10706
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010707 // Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
10708 FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
10709 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
10710 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
10711 if ((FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
10712 FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
10713 FCmpInst *I = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010714 FCmpInst::Predicate NewPred = FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010715 Instruction *NewSCC = new FCmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
10716 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010717 // Swap Destinations and condition...
10718 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
10719 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
10720 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010721 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010722 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010723 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010724 return &BI;
10725 }
10726
10727 // Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
10728 ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
10729 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
10730 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
10731 if ((IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
10732 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
10733 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
10734 ICmpInst *I = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010735 ICmpInst::Predicate NewPred = ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010736 Instruction *NewSCC = new ICmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
10737 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000010738 // Swap Destinations and condition...
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000010739 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000010740 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
10741 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010742 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010743 I->eraseFromParent();;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010744 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000010745 return &BI;
10746 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010747
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000010748 return 0;
10749}
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010750
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000010751Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
10752 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
10753 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
10754 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
10755 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
10756 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
10757 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010758 SI.setOperand(i,ConstantExpr::getSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000010759 AddRHS));
10760 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010761 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000010762 return &SI;
10763 }
10764 }
10765 return 0;
10766}
10767
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000010768Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV) {
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000010769 Value *Agg = EV.getAggregateOperand();
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000010770
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000010771 if (!EV.hasIndices())
10772 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Agg);
10773
10774 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Agg)) {
10775 if (isa<UndefValue>(C))
10776 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, UndefValue::get(EV.getType()));
10777
10778 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(C))
10779 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Constant::getNullValue(EV.getType()));
10780
10781 if (isa<ConstantArray>(C) || isa<ConstantStruct>(C)) {
10782 // Extract the element indexed by the first index out of the constant
10783 Value *V = C->getOperand(*EV.idx_begin());
10784 if (EV.getNumIndices() > 1)
10785 // Extract the remaining indices out of the constant indexed by the
10786 // first index
10787 return ExtractValueInst::Create(V, EV.idx_begin() + 1, EV.idx_end());
10788 else
10789 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, V);
10790 }
10791 return 0; // Can't handle other constants
10792 }
10793 if (InsertValueInst *IV = dyn_cast<InsertValueInst>(Agg)) {
10794 // We're extracting from an insertvalue instruction, compare the indices
10795 const unsigned *exti, *exte, *insi, *inse;
10796 for (exti = EV.idx_begin(), insi = IV->idx_begin(),
10797 exte = EV.idx_end(), inse = IV->idx_end();
10798 exti != exte && insi != inse;
10799 ++exti, ++insi) {
10800 if (*insi != *exti)
10801 // The insert and extract both reference distinctly different elements.
10802 // This means the extract is not influenced by the insert, and we can
10803 // replace the aggregate operand of the extract with the aggregate
10804 // operand of the insert. i.e., replace
10805 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
10806 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 0
10807 // with
10808 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 0
10809 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
10810 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end());
10811 }
10812 if (exti == exte && insi == inse)
10813 // Both iterators are at the end: Index lists are identical. Replace
10814 // %B = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
10815 // %C = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %B, 1, 0
10816 // with "i32 42"
10817 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand());
10818 if (exti == exte) {
10819 // The extract list is a prefix of the insert list. i.e. replace
10820 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
10821 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1
10822 // with
10823 // %X = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 1
10824 // %E = insertvalue { i32 } %X, i32 42, 0
10825 // by switching the order of the insert and extract (though the
10826 // insertvalue should be left in, since it may have other uses).
10827 Value *NewEV = InsertNewInstBefore(
10828 ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
10829 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end()),
10830 EV);
10831 return InsertValueInst::Create(NewEV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
10832 insi, inse);
10833 }
10834 if (insi == inse)
10835 // The insert list is a prefix of the extract list
10836 // We can simply remove the common indices from the extract and make it
10837 // operate on the inserted value instead of the insertvalue result.
10838 // i.e., replace
10839 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
10840 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1, 0
10841 // with
10842 // %E extractvalue { i32 } { i32 42 }, 0
10843 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
10844 exti, exte);
10845 }
10846 // Can't simplify extracts from other values. Note that nested extracts are
10847 // already simplified implicitely by the above (extract ( extract (insert) )
10848 // will be translated into extract ( insert ( extract ) ) first and then just
10849 // the value inserted, if appropriate).
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000010850 return 0;
10851}
10852
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010853/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
10854/// is to leave as a vector operation.
10855static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
10856 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
10857 return true;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010858 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010859 if (isConstant) return true;
10860 // If all elts are the same, we can extract.
10861 Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
10862 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
10863 if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
10864 return false;
10865 return true;
10866 }
10867 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
10868 if (!I) return false;
10869
10870 // Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
10871 // this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
10872 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
10873 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
10874 return true;
10875 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
10876 return true;
10877 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
10878 if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
10879 (CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
10880 CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
10881 return true;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010882 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
10883 if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
10884 (CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
10885 CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
10886 return true;
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010887
10888 return false;
10889}
10890
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +000010891/// Read and decode a shufflevector mask.
10892///
10893/// It turns undef elements into values that are larger than the number of
10894/// elements in the input.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010895static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
10896 unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
10897 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
10898 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
10899 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
10900 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
10901
10902 std::vector<unsigned> Result;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010903 const ConstantVector *CP = cast<ConstantVector>(SVI->getOperand(2));
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010904 for (User::const_op_iterator i = CP->op_begin(), e = CP->op_end(); i!=e; ++i)
10905 if (isa<UndefValue>(*i))
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010906 Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
10907 else
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010908 Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(*i)->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010909 return Result;
10910}
10911
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010912/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
10913/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
10914/// extracted from the vector.
10915static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010916 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
10917 const VectorType *PTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000010918 unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
10919 if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010920 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
10921
10922 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
10923 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
10924 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
10925 return Constant::getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010926 else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010927 return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
10928 else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
10929 // If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010930 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
10931 return 0;
10932 unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010933
10934 // If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
10935 // inserted value.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010936 if (EltNo == IIElt)
10937 return III->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010938
10939 // Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
10940 // vector input.
10941 return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo);
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000010942 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000010943 unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
10944 if (InEl < Width)
10945 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl);
10946 else if (InEl < Width*2)
10947 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - Width);
10948 else
10949 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010950 }
10951
10952 // Otherwise, we don't know.
10953 return 0;
10954}
10955
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010956Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000010957 // If vector val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000010958 if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
10959 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
10960
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000010961 // If vector val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000010962 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
10963 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Constant::getNullValue(EI.getType()));
10964
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010965 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Matthijs Kooijmanb4d6a5a2008-06-11 09:00:12 +000010966 // If vector val is constant with all elements the same, replace EI with
10967 // that element. When the elements are not identical, we cannot replace yet
10968 // (we do that below, but only when the index is constant).
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010969 Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010970 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010971 if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
10972 op0 = 0;
10973 break;
10974 }
10975 if (op0)
10976 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010977 }
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000010978
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000010979 // If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
10980 // find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010981 if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000010982 unsigned IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
10983 unsigned VectorWidth =
10984 cast<VectorType>(EI.getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
10985
10986 // If this is extracting an invalid index, turn this into undef, to avoid
10987 // crashing the code below.
10988 if (IndexVal >= VectorWidth)
10989 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
10990
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000010991 // This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
10992 // If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
10993 // property.
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000010994 if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() && VectorWidth != 1) {
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000010995 uint64_t UndefElts;
10996 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010997 1 << IndexVal,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000010998 UndefElts)) {
10999 EI.setOperand(0, V);
11000 return &EI;
11001 }
11002 }
11003
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011004 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011005 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +000011006
11007 // If the this extractelement is directly using a bitcast from a vector of
11008 // the same number of elements, see if we can find the source element from
11009 // it. In this case, we will end up needing to bitcast the scalars.
11010 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
11011 if (const VectorType *VT =
11012 dyn_cast<VectorType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
11013 if (VT->getNumElements() == VectorWidth)
11014 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(BCI->getOperand(0), IndexVal))
11015 return new BitCastInst(Elt, EI.getType());
11016 }
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000011017 }
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011018
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000011019 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011020 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
11021 // Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
11022 // profitable to do so
11023 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011024 bool isConstantElt = isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1));
11025 if (CheapToScalarize(BO, isConstantElt)) {
11026 ExtractElementInst *newEI0 =
11027 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
11028 EI.getName()+".lhs");
11029 ExtractElementInst *newEI1 =
11030 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
11031 EI.getName()+".rhs");
11032 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI0, EI);
11033 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI1, EI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000011034 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011035 }
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000011036 } else if (isa<LoadInst>(I)) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +000011037 unsigned AS =
11038 cast<PointerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +000011039 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(I->getOperand(0),
11040 PointerType::get(EI.getType(), AS),EI);
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000011041 GetElementPtrInst *GEP =
11042 GetElementPtrInst::Create(Ptr, EI.getOperand(1), I->getName()+".gep");
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011043 InsertNewInstBefore(GEP, EI);
11044 return new LoadInst(GEP);
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000011045 }
11046 }
11047 if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
11048 // Extracting the inserted element?
11049 if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
11050 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
11051 // If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
11052 // be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
11053 if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) &&
11054 isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
11055 AddUsesToWorkList(EI);
11056 EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
11057 return &EI;
11058 }
11059 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
11060 // If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
11061 // it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011062 if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
11063 unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011064 Value *Src;
11065 if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements())
11066 Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
11067 else if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements()*2) {
11068 SrcIdx -= SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
11069 Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
11070 } else {
11071 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdf084ff2006-03-30 22:02:40 +000011072 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011073 return new ExtractElementInst(Src, SrcIdx);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011074 }
11075 }
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000011076 }
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011077 return 0;
11078}
11079
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011080/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
11081/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
11082/// Otherwise, return false.
11083static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
11084 std::vector<Constant*> &Mask) {
11085 assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
11086 "Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011087 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011088
11089 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011090 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011091 return true;
11092 } else if (V == LHS) {
11093 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011094 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011095 return true;
11096 } else if (V == RHS) {
11097 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011098 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i+NumElts));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011099 return true;
11100 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11101 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
11102 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
11103 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
11104 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
11105
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011106 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
11107 return false;
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011108 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011109
11110 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
11111 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
11112 // transitively ok.
11113 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
11114 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011115 Mask[InsertedIdx] = UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011116 return true;
11117 }
11118 } else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
11119 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011120 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
11121 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011122 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011123
11124 // This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
11125 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
11126 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
11127 // transitively ok.
11128 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
11129 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
11130 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011131 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011132 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011133 } else {
11134 assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011135 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011136 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011137
11138 }
11139 return true;
11140 }
11141 }
11142 }
11143 }
11144 }
11145 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
11146
11147 return false;
11148}
11149
11150/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
11151/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
11152/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011153static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011154 Value *&RHS) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011155 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011156 (RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011157 "Invalid shuffle!");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011158 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011159
11160 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011161 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011162 return V;
11163 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011164 Mask.assign(NumElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011165 return V;
11166 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11167 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
11168 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
11169 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
11170 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
11171
11172 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
11173 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
11174 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
11175 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011176 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
11177 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011178
11179 // Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
11180 // otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011181 if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
11182 RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
11183 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011184 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011185 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011186 return V;
11187 }
11188
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011189 if (VecOp == RHS) {
11190 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011191 // Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
11192 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
11193 if (i != InsertedIdx)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011194 Mask[i] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+i);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011195 }
11196 return V;
11197 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011198
11199 // If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
11200 // vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
11201 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask))
11202 return EI->getOperand(0);
11203
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011204 }
11205 }
11206 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011207 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011208
11209 // Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
11210 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011211 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011212 return V;
11213}
11214
11215Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
11216 Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
11217 Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
11218 Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
11219
Chris Lattner599ded12007-04-09 01:11:16 +000011220 // Inserting an undef or into an undefined place, remove this.
11221 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp) || isa<UndefValue>(IdxOp))
11222 ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11223
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011224 // If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
11225 // indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
11226 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
11227 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
11228 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
11229 unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +000011230 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
11231 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011232 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011233
11234 if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
11235 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11236
11237 if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
11238 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, UndefValue::get(IE.getType()));
11239
11240 // If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
11241 // back into the same place, just use the input vector.
11242 if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
11243 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11244
11245 // We could theoretically do this for ANY input. However, doing so could
11246 // turn chains of insertelement instructions into a chain of shufflevector
11247 // instructions, and right now we do not merge shufflevectors. As such,
11248 // only do this in a situation where it is clear that there is benefit.
11249 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp) || isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp)) {
11250 // Turn this into shuffle(EIOp0, VecOp, Mask). The result has all of
11251 // the values of VecOp, except then one read from EIOp0.
11252 // Build a new shuffle mask.
11253 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
11254 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011255 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011256 else {
11257 assert(isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp) && "Unknown thing");
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011258 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011259 NumVectorElts));
11260 }
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011261 Mask[InsertedIdx] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011262 return new ShuffleVectorInst(EI->getOperand(0), VecOp,
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011263 ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011264 }
11265
11266 // If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
11267 // (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
11268 if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
11269 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011270 Value *RHS = 0;
11271 Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS);
11272 if (RHS == 0) RHS = UndefValue::get(LHS->getType());
11273 // We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011274 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011275 }
11276 }
11277 }
11278
11279 return 0;
11280}
11281
11282
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011283Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
11284 Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11285 Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011286 std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011287
11288 bool MadeChange = false;
11289
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011290 // Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011291 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011292 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, UndefValue::get(SVI.getType()));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000011293
11294 uint64_t UndefElts;
11295 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(SVI.getType())->getNumElements();
11296 uint64_t AllOnesEltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
11297 if (VWidth <= 64 &&
11298 SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(&SVI, AllOnesEltMask, UndefElts))
11299 MadeChange = true;
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011300
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011301 // Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
11302 // Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
11303 if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
11304 if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011305 // shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
11306 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
11307 }
11308
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011309 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
11310 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
11311 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011312 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011313 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011314 else {
11315 if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000011316 (Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS))) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011317 Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000011318 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
11319 } else {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011320 Mask[i] = Mask[i] % e; // Force to LHS.
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000011321 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
11322 }
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011323 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011324 }
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011325 SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011326 SVI.setOperand(1, UndefValue::get(RHS->getType()));
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011327 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011328 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11329 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011330 MadeChange = true;
11331 }
11332
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011333 // Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011334 bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000011335
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011336 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11337 if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
11338 // Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
11339 isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
11340
11341 // Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
11342 isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000011343 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011344
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011345 // Eliminate identity shuffles.
11346 if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
11347 if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011348
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011349 // If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
11350 // one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
11351 // we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
11352 // program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
11353 // shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
11354 // we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
11355 // masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
11356 // which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
11357 // (splat(splat)) -> splat.
11358 if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
11359 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
11360 std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
11361
11362 std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
11363 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
11364 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
11365 NewMask.push_back(2*e);
11366 else
11367 NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
11368
11369 // If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this shuffle mask, do
11370 // the replacement.
11371 if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
11372 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
11373 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
11374 if (NewMask[i] >= e*2) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011375 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011376 } else {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011377 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NewMask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011378 }
11379 }
11380 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
11381 LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011382 ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000011383 }
11384 }
11385 }
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +000011386
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011387 return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
11388}
11389
11390
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011391
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011392
11393/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
11394/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
11395/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
11396/// end of its block.
11397static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
11398 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
11399
Chris Lattner108e9022005-10-27 17:13:11 +000011400 // Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
Chris Lattnerbfc538c2008-05-09 15:07:33 +000011401 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayWriteToMemory() || isa<TerminatorInst>(I))
11402 return false;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011403
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011404 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
Dan Gohmanecb7a772007-03-22 16:38:57 +000011405 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() ==
11406 &DestBlock->getParent()->getEntryBlock())
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011407 return false;
11408
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011409 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
11410 // the end of block that could change the value.
Chris Lattner2539e332008-05-08 17:37:37 +000011411 if (I->mayReadFromMemory()) {
11412 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = I, E = I->getParent()->end();
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011413 Scan != E; ++Scan)
11414 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
11415 return false;
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000011416 }
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011417
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000011418 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011419
Chris Lattner4bc5f802005-08-08 19:11:57 +000011420 I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011421 ++NumSunkInst;
11422 return true;
11423}
11424
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011425
11426/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
11427/// all reachable code to the worklist.
11428///
11429/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
11430/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
11431/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
11432/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
11433/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
11434///
11435static void AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000011436 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> &Visited,
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011437 InstCombiner &IC,
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011438 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner2806dff2008-08-15 04:03:01 +000011439 SmallVector<BasicBlock*, 256> Worklist;
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011440 Worklist.push_back(BB);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011441
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011442 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
11443 BB = Worklist.back();
11444 Worklist.pop_back();
11445
11446 // We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, ignore it.
11447 if (!Visited.insert(BB)) continue;
11448
11449 for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
11450 Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011451
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011452 // DCE instruction if trivially dead.
11453 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
11454 ++NumDeadInst;
11455 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst;
11456 Inst->eraseFromParent();
11457 continue;
11458 }
11459
11460 // ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
11461 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, TD)) {
11462 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *Inst;
11463 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
11464 ++NumConstProp;
11465 Inst->eraseFromParent();
11466 continue;
11467 }
Chris Lattner3ccc6bc2007-07-20 22:06:41 +000011468
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011469 IC.AddToWorkList(Inst);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011470 }
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011471
11472 // Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a
11473 // constant, only visit the reachable successor.
11474 TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
11475 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
11476 if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
11477 bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000011478 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000011479 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011480 continue;
11481 }
11482 } else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
11483 if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
11484 // See if this is an explicit destination.
11485 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
11486 if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000011487 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = SI->getSuccessor(i);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000011488 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000011489 continue;
11490 }
11491
11492 // Otherwise it is the default destination.
11493 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(0));
11494 continue;
11495 }
11496 }
11497
11498 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
11499 Worklist.push_back(TI->getSuccessor(i));
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011500 }
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011501}
11502
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011503bool InstCombiner::DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned Iteration) {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011504 bool Changed = false;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000011505 TD = &getAnalysis<TargetData>();
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011506
11507 DEBUG(DOUT << "\n\nINSTCOMBINE ITERATION #" << Iteration << " on "
11508 << F.getNameStr() << "\n");
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011509
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000011510 {
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011511 // Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
11512 // the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
11513 // track of which blocks we visit.
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000011514 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> Visited;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011515 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, *this, TD);
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +000011516
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000011517 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
11518 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
11519 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
11520 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
11521 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
11522 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
11523 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
11524 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
Chris Lattner6ffe5512004-04-27 15:13:33 +000011525
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011526 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000011527 ++NumDeadInst;
11528
11529 if (!I->use_empty())
11530 I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
11531 I->eraseFromParent();
11532 }
11533 }
11534 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011535
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011536 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
11537 Instruction *I = RemoveOneFromWorkList();
11538 if (I == 0) continue; // skip null values.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011539
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011540 // Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011541 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011542 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011543 if (I->getNumOperands() < 4)
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000011544 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011545 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011546
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011547 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000011548
11549 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011550 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011551 continue;
11552 }
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011553
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011554 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
Chris Lattner0a19ffa2007-01-30 23:16:15 +000011555 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, TD)) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011556 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000011557
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000011558 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000011559 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerc736d562002-12-05 22:41:53 +000011560 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
11561
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011562 ++NumConstProp;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000011563 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011564 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011565 continue;
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011566 }
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011567
Nick Lewycky3dfd7bf2008-05-25 20:56:15 +000011568 if (TD && I->getType()->getTypeID() == Type::VoidTyID) {
11569 // See if we can constant fold its operands.
11570 for (User::op_iterator i = I->op_begin(), e = I->op_end(); i != e; ++i) {
11571 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(i)) {
11572 if (Constant *NewC = ConstantFoldConstantExpression(CE, TD))
11573 i->set(NewC);
11574 }
11575 }
11576 }
11577
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011578 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
Dan Gohmanfc74abf2008-07-23 00:34:11 +000011579 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000011580 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
11581 BasicBlock *UserParent = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back())->getParent();
11582 if (UserParent != BB) {
11583 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
11584 // See if the user is one of our successors.
11585 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
11586 if (*SI == UserParent) {
11587 UserIsSuccessor = true;
11588 break;
11589 }
11590
11591 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
11592 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
11593 // otherwise), we can keep going.
11594 if (UserIsSuccessor && !isa<PHINode>(I->use_back()) &&
11595 next(pred_begin(UserParent)) == pred_end(UserParent))
11596 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
11597 Changed |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
11598 }
11599 }
11600
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011601 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it...
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000011602#ifndef NDEBUG
11603 std::string OrigI;
11604#endif
11605 DEBUG(std::ostringstream SS; I->print(SS); OrigI = SS.str(););
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011606 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
Chris Lattner3dec1f22002-05-10 15:38:35 +000011607 ++NumCombined;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011608 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000011609 if (Result != I) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000011610 DOUT << "IC: Old = " << *I
11611 << " New = " << *Result;
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000011612
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000011613 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
11614 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
11615
11616 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011617 AddToWorkList(Result);
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000011618 AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011619
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011620 // Move the name to the new instruction first.
11621 Result->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011622
11623 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
11624 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000011625 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
11626
11627 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
11628 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
11629 ++InsertPos;
11630
11631 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011632
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000011633 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
11634 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011635 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner216d4d82004-05-01 23:19:52 +000011636
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000011637 // Instructions can end up on the worklist more than once. Make sure
11638 // we do not process an instruction that has been deleted.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011639 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000011640
11641 // Erase the old instruction.
11642 InstParent->getInstList().erase(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000011643 } else {
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000011644#ifndef NDEBUG
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000011645 DOUT << "IC: Mod = " << OrigI
11646 << " New = " << *I;
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000011647#endif
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000011648
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011649 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
11650 // if so, remove it.
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000011651 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
11652 // Make sure we process all operands now that we are reducing their
11653 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011654 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011655
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000011656 // Instructions may end up in the worklist more than once. Erase all
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011657 // occurrences of this instruction.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011658 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011659 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000011660 } else {
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011661 AddToWorkList(I);
11662 AddUsersToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011663 }
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000011664 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011665 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011666 }
11667 }
11668
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011669 assert(WorklistMap.empty() && "Worklist empty, but map not?");
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +000011670
11671 // Do an explicit clear, this shrinks the map if needed.
11672 WorklistMap.clear();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011673 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000011674}
11675
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011676
11677bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000011678 MustPreserveLCSSA = mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID);
11679
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011680 bool EverMadeChange = false;
11681
11682 // Iterate while there is work to do.
11683 unsigned Iteration = 0;
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +000011684 while (DoOneIteration(F, Iteration++))
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000011685 EverMadeChange = true;
11686 return EverMadeChange;
11687}
11688
Brian Gaeke96d4bf72004-07-27 17:43:21 +000011689FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000011690 return new InstCombiner();
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000011691}
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000011692
Chris Lattnerb8cd4d32008-08-11 22:06:05 +000011693